2013-05-03 Richard Biener <rguenther@suse.de>
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / expr.c
blobacf282e7808784c2b449d8c7f88c2684d4cd5e7a
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 This file is part of GCC.
6 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
7 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
8 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
9 version.
11 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
12 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
13 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
14 for more details.
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
18 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 #include "config.h"
21 #include "system.h"
22 #include "coretypes.h"
23 #include "tm.h"
24 #include "machmode.h"
25 #include "rtl.h"
26 #include "tree.h"
27 #include "flags.h"
28 #include "regs.h"
29 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
30 #include "except.h"
31 #include "function.h"
32 #include "insn-config.h"
33 #include "insn-attr.h"
34 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
35 #include "expr.h"
36 #include "optabs.h"
37 #include "libfuncs.h"
38 #include "recog.h"
39 #include "reload.h"
40 #include "typeclass.h"
41 #include "toplev.h"
42 #include "langhooks.h"
43 #include "intl.h"
44 #include "tm_p.h"
45 #include "tree-iterator.h"
46 #include "tree-flow.h"
47 #include "target.h"
48 #include "common/common-target.h"
49 #include "timevar.h"
50 #include "df.h"
51 #include "diagnostic.h"
52 #include "ssaexpand.h"
53 #include "target-globals.h"
54 #include "params.h"
56 /* Decide whether a function's arguments should be processed
57 from first to last or from last to first.
59 They should if the stack and args grow in opposite directions, but
60 only if we have push insns. */
62 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
64 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
65 #if defined (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD) != defined (ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD)
66 #define PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED /* If it's last to first. */
67 #endif
68 #endif
70 #endif
72 #ifndef STACK_PUSH_CODE
73 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
74 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_DEC
75 #else
76 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_INC
77 #endif
78 #endif
81 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
82 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
83 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
84 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
85 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
86 the same indirect address eventually. */
87 int cse_not_expected;
89 /* This structure is used by move_by_pieces to describe the move to
90 be performed. */
91 struct move_by_pieces_d
93 rtx to;
94 rtx to_addr;
95 int autinc_to;
96 int explicit_inc_to;
97 rtx from;
98 rtx from_addr;
99 int autinc_from;
100 int explicit_inc_from;
101 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
102 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
103 int reverse;
106 /* This structure is used by store_by_pieces to describe the clear to
107 be performed. */
109 struct store_by_pieces_d
111 rtx to;
112 rtx to_addr;
113 int autinc_to;
114 int explicit_inc_to;
115 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
116 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
117 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
118 void *constfundata;
119 int reverse;
122 static void move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
123 struct move_by_pieces_d *);
124 static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
125 static bool emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
126 static tree emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int);
127 static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
128 static rtx clear_by_pieces_1 (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
129 static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
130 static void store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *, unsigned int);
131 static void store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
132 struct store_by_pieces_d *);
133 static tree clear_storage_libcall_fn (int);
134 static rtx compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
135 static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
136 static void store_constructor_field (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
137 HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
138 tree, int, alias_set_type);
139 static void store_constructor (tree, rtx, int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
140 static rtx store_field (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT,
141 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
142 enum machine_mode, tree, alias_set_type, bool);
144 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree, const_tree);
146 static int is_aligning_offset (const_tree, const_tree);
147 static void expand_operands (tree, tree, rtx, rtx*, rtx*,
148 enum expand_modifier);
149 static rtx reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx, rtx, tree);
150 static rtx do_store_flag (sepops, rtx, enum machine_mode);
151 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
152 static void emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode, rtx, tree);
153 #endif
154 static void do_tablejump (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
155 static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
156 static void write_complex_part (rtx, rtx, bool);
158 /* This macro is used to determine whether move_by_pieces should be called
159 to perform a structure copy. */
160 #ifndef MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
161 #define MOVE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
162 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
163 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
164 #endif
166 /* This macro is used to determine whether clear_by_pieces should be
167 called to clear storage. */
168 #ifndef CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
169 #define CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
170 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
171 < (unsigned int) CLEAR_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
172 #endif
174 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
175 called to "memset" storage with byte values other than zero. */
176 #ifndef SET_BY_PIECES_P
177 #define SET_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
178 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
179 < (unsigned int) SET_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
180 #endif
182 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
183 called to "memcpy" storage when the source is a constant string. */
184 #ifndef STORE_BY_PIECES_P
185 #define STORE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
186 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
187 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
188 #endif
190 /* This is run to set up which modes can be used
191 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. It is run
192 at the beginning of compilation and when the target is reinitialized. */
194 void
195 init_expr_target (void)
197 rtx insn, pat;
198 enum machine_mode mode;
199 int num_clobbers;
200 rtx mem, mem1;
201 rtx reg;
203 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
204 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
205 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
206 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
207 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, frame_pointer_rtx);
209 /* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
210 useless RTL allocations. */
211 reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
213 insn = rtx_alloc (INSN);
214 pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
215 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
217 for (mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
218 mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
220 int regno;
222 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
223 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
224 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
225 PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
227 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
228 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
230 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
231 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
232 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
233 regno++)
235 if (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode))
236 continue;
238 SET_REGNO (reg, regno);
240 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
241 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
242 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
243 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
245 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
246 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
247 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
248 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
250 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
251 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
252 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
253 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
255 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
256 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
257 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
258 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
262 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_raw_REG (Pmode, 10000));
264 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); mode != VOIDmode;
265 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
267 enum machine_mode srcmode;
268 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); srcmode != mode;
269 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
271 enum insn_code ic;
273 ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
274 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
275 continue;
277 PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
279 if (insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, mem))
280 float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
285 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
287 void
288 init_expr (void)
290 memset (&crtl->expr, 0, sizeof (crtl->expr));
293 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
294 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating, or both may be
295 fixed-point.
296 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
297 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
299 void
300 convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
302 enum machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
303 enum machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
304 int to_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode);
305 int from_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode);
306 enum insn_code code;
307 rtx libcall;
309 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
310 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
311 : (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
314 gcc_assert (to_real == from_real);
315 gcc_assert (to_mode != BLKmode);
316 gcc_assert (from_mode != BLKmode);
318 /* If the source and destination are already the same, then there's
319 nothing to do. */
320 if (to == from)
321 return;
323 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
324 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
325 TO here. */
327 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
328 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)))
329 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
330 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (from) == unsignedp)
331 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, from), from_mode = to_mode;
333 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (to) != SUBREG || !SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to));
335 if (to_mode == from_mode
336 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
338 emit_move_insn (to, from);
339 return;
342 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
344 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode));
346 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
347 from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
348 else
349 to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
351 emit_move_insn (to, from);
352 return;
355 if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
357 convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
358 convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
359 return;
362 if (to_real)
364 rtx value, insns;
365 convert_optab tab;
367 gcc_assert ((GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
368 != GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
369 || (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode)
370 != DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode)));
372 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) == GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
373 /* Conversion between decimal float and binary float, same size. */
374 tab = DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode) ? trunc_optab : sext_optab;
375 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
376 tab = sext_optab;
377 else
378 tab = trunc_optab;
380 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
382 code = convert_optab_handler (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
383 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
385 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from,
386 tab == sext_optab ? FLOAT_EXTEND : FLOAT_TRUNCATE);
387 return;
390 /* Otherwise use a libcall. */
391 libcall = convert_optab_libfunc (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
393 /* Is this conversion implemented yet? */
394 gcc_assert (libcall);
396 start_sequence ();
397 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
398 1, from, from_mode);
399 insns = get_insns ();
400 end_sequence ();
401 emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value,
402 tab == trunc_optab ? gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
403 from)
404 : gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (to_mode, from));
405 return;
408 /* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
409 /* Targets are expected to provide conversion insns between PxImode and
410 xImode for all MODE_PARTIAL_INT modes they use, but no others. */
411 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
413 enum machine_mode full_mode
414 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode), MODE_INT);
416 gcc_assert (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode)
417 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
419 if (full_mode != from_mode)
420 from = convert_to_mode (full_mode, from, unsignedp);
421 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode),
422 to, from, UNKNOWN);
423 return;
425 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
427 rtx new_from;
428 enum machine_mode full_mode
429 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode), MODE_INT);
430 convert_optab ctab = unsignedp ? zext_optab : sext_optab;
431 enum insn_code icode;
433 icode = convert_optab_handler (ctab, full_mode, from_mode);
434 gcc_assert (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing);
436 if (to_mode == full_mode)
438 emit_unop_insn (icode, to, from, UNKNOWN);
439 return;
442 new_from = gen_reg_rtx (full_mode);
443 emit_unop_insn (icode, new_from, from, UNKNOWN);
445 /* else proceed to integer conversions below. */
446 from_mode = full_mode;
447 from = new_from;
450 /* Make sure both are fixed-point modes or both are not. */
451 gcc_assert (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode) ==
452 ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (to_mode));
453 if (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode))
455 /* If we widen from_mode to to_mode and they are in the same class,
456 we won't saturate the result.
457 Otherwise, always saturate the result to play safe. */
458 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode)
459 && GET_MODE_SIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
460 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 0);
461 else
462 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 1);
463 return;
466 /* Now both modes are integers. */
468 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
469 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
470 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
472 rtx insns;
473 rtx lowpart;
474 rtx fill_value;
475 rtx lowfrom;
476 int i;
477 enum machine_mode lowpart_mode;
478 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
480 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
481 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
482 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
484 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
485 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
486 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
487 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
488 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
489 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
490 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
491 return;
493 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
494 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
495 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
496 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
498 rtx word_to = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
499 if (REG_P (to))
501 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
502 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
503 emit_clobber (to);
505 convert_move (word_to, from, unsignedp);
506 emit_unop_insn (code, to, word_to, equiv_code);
507 return;
510 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
511 start_sequence ();
513 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure the
514 the source does not overlap the target so force it into an isolated
515 register when maybe so. Likewise for any MEM input, since the
516 conversion sequence might require several references to it and we
517 must ensure we're getting the same value every time. */
519 if (MEM_P (from) || reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
520 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
522 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
523 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
524 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
525 else
526 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
528 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
530 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
531 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
533 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
534 if (unsignedp)
535 fill_value = const0_rtx;
536 else
537 fill_value = emit_store_flag (gen_reg_rtx (word_mode),
538 LT, lowfrom, const0_rtx,
539 VOIDmode, 0, -1);
541 /* Fill the remaining words. */
542 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
544 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
545 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
547 gcc_assert (subword);
549 if (fill_value != subword)
550 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
553 insns = get_insns ();
554 end_sequence ();
556 emit_insn (insns);
557 return;
560 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
561 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
562 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
564 if (!((MEM_P (from)
565 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
566 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
567 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
568 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
569 || REG_P (from)
570 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
571 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
572 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
573 return;
576 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
577 no more than a word long. */
579 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
580 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
581 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, from_mode))
583 if (!((MEM_P (from)
584 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
585 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
586 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
587 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
588 || REG_P (from)
589 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
590 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
591 if (REG_P (from) && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
592 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (from), to_mode))
593 from = copy_to_reg (from);
594 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
595 return;
598 /* Handle extension. */
599 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
601 /* Convert directly if that works. */
602 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
603 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
605 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
606 return;
608 else
610 enum machine_mode intermediate;
611 rtx tmp;
612 int shift_amount;
614 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
615 for (intermediate = from_mode; intermediate != VOIDmode;
616 intermediate = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (intermediate))
617 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
618 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
619 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
620 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, intermediate)))
621 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
622 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
624 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
625 unsignedp), unsignedp);
626 return;
629 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
630 Generate what we need with shifts. */
631 shift_amount = (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
632 - GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode));
633 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
634 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
635 to, unsignedp);
636 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
637 to, unsignedp);
638 if (tmp != to)
639 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
640 return;
644 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
645 if (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode,
646 from_mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
648 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, from_mode),
649 to, from, UNKNOWN);
650 return;
653 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
654 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
655 and for which there was no special instruction.
657 ??? Code above formerly short-circuited this, for most integer
658 mode pairs, with a force_reg in from_mode followed by a recursive
659 call to this routine. Appears always to have been wrong. */
660 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
662 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
663 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
664 return;
667 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
668 gcc_unreachable ();
671 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
672 from converting X to mode MODE.
673 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
674 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
675 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
676 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion. */
679 convert_to_mode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
681 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
684 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
685 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
686 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
687 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
689 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
690 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
692 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode. */
695 convert_modes (enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
697 rtx temp;
699 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
700 the required extension, strip it. */
702 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
703 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
704 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (x) == unsignedp)
705 x = gen_lowpart (mode, x);
707 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
708 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
710 if (mode == oldmode)
711 return x;
713 /* There is one case that we must handle specially: If we are converting
714 a CONST_INT into a mode whose size is twice HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT and
715 we are to interpret the constant as unsigned, gen_lowpart will do
716 the wrong if the constant appears negative. What we want to do is
717 make the high-order word of the constant zero, not all ones. */
719 if (unsignedp && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
720 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
721 && CONST_INT_P (x) && INTVAL (x) < 0)
723 double_int val = double_int::from_uhwi (INTVAL (x));
725 /* We need to zero extend VAL. */
726 if (oldmode != VOIDmode)
727 val = val.zext (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
729 return immed_double_int_const (val, mode);
732 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
733 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
734 non-volatile MEM. Except for the constant case where MODE is no
735 wider than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, we must be narrowing the operand. */
737 if ((CONST_INT_P (x)
738 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
739 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
740 && GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) == MODE_INT
741 && (CONST_DOUBLE_AS_INT_P (x)
742 || (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= GET_MODE_PRECISION (oldmode)
743 && ((MEM_P (x) && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (x)
744 && direct_load[(int) mode])
745 || (REG_P (x)
746 && (! HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
747 || HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (x), mode))
748 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (mode,
749 GET_MODE (x))))))))
751 /* ?? If we don't know OLDMODE, we have to assume here that
752 X does not need sign- or zero-extension. This may not be
753 the case, but it's the best we can do. */
754 if (CONST_INT_P (x) && oldmode != VOIDmode
755 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (oldmode))
757 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
759 /* We must sign or zero-extend in this case. Start by
760 zero-extending, then sign extend if we need to. */
761 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (oldmode);
762 if (! unsignedp
763 && val_signbit_known_set_p (oldmode, val))
764 val |= ~GET_MODE_MASK (oldmode);
766 return gen_int_mode (val, mode);
769 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
772 /* Converting from integer constant into mode is always equivalent to an
773 subreg operation. */
774 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode) && GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
776 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
777 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, x, oldmode, 0);
780 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
781 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
782 return temp;
785 /* Return the largest alignment we can use for doing a move (or store)
786 of MAX_PIECES. ALIGN is the largest alignment we could use. */
788 static unsigned int
789 alignment_for_piecewise_move (unsigned int max_pieces, unsigned int align)
791 enum machine_mode tmode;
793 tmode = mode_for_size (max_pieces * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
794 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
795 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
796 else
798 enum machine_mode tmode, xmode;
800 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
801 tmode != VOIDmode;
802 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
803 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > max_pieces
804 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
805 break;
807 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
810 return align;
813 /* Return the widest integer mode no wider than SIZE. If no such mode
814 can be found, return VOIDmode. */
816 static enum machine_mode
817 widest_int_mode_for_size (unsigned int size)
819 enum machine_mode tmode, mode = VOIDmode;
821 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
822 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
823 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < size)
824 mode = tmode;
826 return mode;
829 /* STORE_MAX_PIECES is the number of bytes at a time that we can
830 store efficiently. Due to internal GCC limitations, this is
831 MOVE_MAX_PIECES limited by the number of bytes GCC can represent
832 for an immediate constant. */
834 #define STORE_MAX_PIECES MIN (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
836 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
837 instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
838 succeed. */
841 can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
842 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
844 return MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align);
847 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
848 block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
850 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
851 used to push FROM to the stack.
853 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
855 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
856 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
857 stpcpy. */
860 move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
861 unsigned int align, int endp)
863 struct move_by_pieces_d data;
864 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode;
865 enum machine_mode from_addr_mode = get_address_mode (from);
866 rtx to_addr, from_addr = XEXP (from, 0);
867 unsigned int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
868 enum insn_code icode;
870 align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align, MEM_ALIGN (from));
872 data.offset = 0;
873 data.from_addr = from_addr;
874 if (to)
876 to_addr_mode = get_address_mode (to);
877 to_addr = XEXP (to, 0);
878 data.to = to;
879 data.autinc_to
880 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
881 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
882 data.reverse
883 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
885 else
887 to_addr_mode = VOIDmode;
888 to_addr = NULL_RTX;
889 data.to = NULL_RTX;
890 data.autinc_to = 1;
891 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
892 data.reverse = 1;
893 #else
894 data.reverse = 0;
895 #endif
897 data.to_addr = to_addr;
898 data.from = from;
899 data.autinc_from
900 = (GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_DEC
901 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_INC
902 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_DEC);
904 data.explicit_inc_from = 0;
905 data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
906 if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
907 data.len = len;
909 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
910 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
911 and use post-increment if available. */
912 if (!(data.autinc_from && data.autinc_to)
913 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align, max_size) > 2)
915 /* Find the mode of the largest move...
916 MODE might not be used depending on the definitions of the
917 USE_* macros below. */
918 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
919 = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
921 if (USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_from)
923 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode,
924 plus_constant (from_addr_mode,
925 from_addr, len));
926 data.autinc_from = 1;
927 data.explicit_inc_from = -1;
929 if (USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.autinc_from)
931 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
932 data.autinc_from = 1;
933 data.explicit_inc_from = 1;
935 if (!data.autinc_from && CONSTANT_P (from_addr))
936 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
937 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
939 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
940 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
941 to_addr, len));
942 data.autinc_to = 1;
943 data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
945 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
947 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
948 data.autinc_to = 1;
949 data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
951 if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
952 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
955 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
957 /* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
958 successively smaller modes. */
960 while (max_size > 1 && data.len > 0)
962 enum machine_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
964 if (mode == VOIDmode)
965 break;
967 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
968 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
969 move_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
971 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
974 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
975 gcc_assert (!data.len);
977 if (endp)
979 rtx to1;
981 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
982 if (data.autinc_to)
984 if (endp == 2)
986 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
987 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
988 else
989 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
990 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
991 data.to_addr,
992 -1));
994 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
995 data.offset);
997 else
999 if (endp == 2)
1000 --data.offset;
1001 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
1003 return to1;
1005 else
1006 return data.to;
1009 /* Return number of insns required to move L bytes by pieces.
1010 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
1012 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
1013 move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align,
1014 unsigned int max_size)
1016 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
1018 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
1020 while (max_size > 1 && l > 0)
1022 enum machine_mode mode;
1023 enum insn_code icode;
1025 mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
1027 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1028 break;
1030 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1031 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1032 n_insns += l / GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), l %= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1034 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1037 gcc_assert (!l);
1038 return n_insns;
1041 /* Subroutine of move_by_pieces. Move as many bytes as appropriate
1042 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
1043 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
1045 static void
1046 move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
1047 struct move_by_pieces_d *data)
1049 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1050 rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
1052 while (data->len >= size)
1054 if (data->reverse)
1055 data->offset -= size;
1057 if (data->to)
1059 if (data->autinc_to)
1060 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
1061 data->offset);
1062 else
1063 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
1066 if (data->autinc_from)
1067 from1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->from, mode, data->from_addr,
1068 data->offset);
1069 else
1070 from1 = adjust_address (data->from, mode, data->offset);
1072 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
1073 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
1074 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1075 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from < 0)
1076 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr,
1077 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1079 if (data->to)
1080 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, from1));
1081 else
1083 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1084 emit_single_push_insn (mode, from1, NULL);
1085 #else
1086 gcc_unreachable ();
1087 #endif
1090 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
1091 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1092 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from > 0)
1093 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1095 if (! data->reverse)
1096 data->offset += size;
1098 data->len -= size;
1102 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
1103 string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
1104 or with a library call.
1106 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
1107 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1108 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
1109 METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
1111 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1112 0 otherwise. */
1115 emit_block_move_hints (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
1116 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
1118 bool may_use_call;
1119 rtx retval = 0;
1120 unsigned int align;
1122 gcc_assert (size);
1123 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
1124 && INTVAL (size) == 0)
1125 return 0;
1127 switch (method)
1129 case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
1130 case BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL:
1131 may_use_call = true;
1132 break;
1134 case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
1135 may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
1137 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
1138 to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
1139 NO_DEFER_POP;
1140 break;
1142 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
1143 may_use_call = false;
1144 break;
1146 default:
1147 gcc_unreachable ();
1150 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y));
1151 align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
1152 gcc_assert (align >= BITS_PER_UNIT);
1154 /* Make sure we've got BLKmode addresses; store_one_arg can decide that
1155 block copy is more efficient for other large modes, e.g. DCmode. */
1156 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
1157 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
1159 /* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
1160 can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
1161 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
1163 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
1164 y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
1165 set_mem_size (x, INTVAL (size));
1166 set_mem_size (y, INTVAL (size));
1169 if (CONST_INT_P (size) && MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
1170 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, 0);
1171 else if (emit_block_move_via_movmem (x, y, size, align,
1172 expected_align, expected_size))
1174 else if (may_use_call
1175 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
1176 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
1178 /* Since x and y are passed to a libcall, mark the corresponding
1179 tree EXPR as addressable. */
1180 tree y_expr = MEM_EXPR (y);
1181 tree x_expr = MEM_EXPR (x);
1182 if (y_expr)
1183 mark_addressable (y_expr);
1184 if (x_expr)
1185 mark_addressable (x_expr);
1186 retval = emit_block_move_via_libcall (x, y, size,
1187 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
1190 else
1191 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align);
1193 if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
1194 OK_DEFER_POP;
1196 return retval;
1200 emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
1202 return emit_block_move_hints (x, y, size, method, 0, -1);
1205 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
1206 block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
1207 already been placed on the stack. */
1209 static bool
1210 block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
1212 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1213 tree fn;
1214 #endif
1216 /* If arguments are pushed on the stack, then they're safe. */
1217 if (PUSH_ARGS)
1218 return true;
1220 /* If registers go on the stack anyway, any argument is sure to clobber
1221 an outgoing argument. */
1222 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1223 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1224 /* Avoid set but not used warning if *REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE doesn't
1225 depend on its argument. */
1226 (void) fn;
1227 if (OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE ((!fn ? NULL_TREE : TREE_TYPE (fn)))
1228 && REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fn) != 0)
1229 return false;
1230 #endif
1232 /* If any argument goes in memory, then it might clobber an outgoing
1233 argument. */
1235 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v;
1236 cumulative_args_t args_so_far;
1237 tree fn, arg;
1239 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1240 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0, 3);
1241 args_so_far = pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v);
1243 arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
1244 for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
1246 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
1247 rtx tmp = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
1248 NULL_TREE, true);
1249 if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
1250 return false;
1251 if (targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (args_so_far, mode, NULL, 1))
1252 return false;
1253 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, mode,
1254 NULL_TREE, true);
1257 return true;
1260 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a movmem pattern;
1261 return true if successful. */
1263 static bool
1264 emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align,
1265 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
1267 int save_volatile_ok = volatile_ok;
1268 enum machine_mode mode;
1270 if (expected_align < align)
1271 expected_align = align;
1273 /* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
1274 volatile_ok = 1;
1276 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
1277 including more than one in the machine description unless
1278 the more limited one has some advantage. */
1280 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
1281 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
1283 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (movmem_optab, mode);
1285 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
1286 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
1287 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
1288 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
1289 actual mode mask. */
1290 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
1291 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
1292 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
1293 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD))
1295 struct expand_operand ops[6];
1296 unsigned int nops;
1298 /* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
1299 nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
1300 that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
1301 emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
1302 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
1303 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6);
1305 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], x);
1306 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], y);
1307 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
1308 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[2], size, mode, true);
1309 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1310 if (nops == 6)
1312 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1313 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
1315 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
1317 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1318 return true;
1323 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1324 return false;
1327 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a call to memcpy.
1328 Return the return value from memcpy, 0 otherwise. */
1331 emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx dst, rtx src, rtx size, bool tailcall)
1333 rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
1334 tree call_expr, fn, src_tree, dst_tree, size_tree;
1335 enum machine_mode size_mode;
1336 rtx retval;
1338 /* Emit code to copy the addresses of DST and SRC and SIZE into new
1339 pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and
1340 use them later. */
1342 dst_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (dst, 0));
1343 src_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (src, 0));
1345 dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
1346 src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
1348 dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
1349 src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
1351 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
1353 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
1354 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
1356 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
1357 memcpy in this context. This could be a user call to memcpy and
1358 the user may wish to examine the return value from memcpy. For
1359 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
1360 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
1362 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
1364 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (true);
1365 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, dst_tree, src_tree, size_tree);
1366 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
1368 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
1370 return retval;
1373 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move_via_libcall. Create the tree node
1374 for the function we use for block copies. */
1376 static GTY(()) tree block_move_fn;
1378 void
1379 init_block_move_fn (const char *asmspec)
1381 if (!block_move_fn)
1383 tree args, fn, attrs, attr_args;
1385 fn = get_identifier ("memcpy");
1386 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
1387 const_ptr_type_node, sizetype,
1388 NULL_TREE);
1390 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
1391 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
1392 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
1393 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
1394 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
1395 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
1396 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
1398 attr_args = build_tree_list (NULL_TREE, build_string (1, "1"));
1399 attrs = tree_cons (get_identifier ("fn spec"), attr_args, NULL);
1401 decl_attributes (&fn, attrs, ATTR_FLAG_BUILT_IN);
1403 block_move_fn = fn;
1406 if (asmspec)
1407 set_user_assembler_name (block_move_fn, asmspec);
1410 static tree
1411 emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int for_call)
1413 static bool emitted_extern;
1415 if (!block_move_fn)
1416 init_block_move_fn (NULL);
1418 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
1420 emitted_extern = true;
1421 make_decl_rtl (block_move_fn);
1424 return block_move_fn;
1427 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
1428 loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden. */
1429 /* ??? It'd be nice to copy in hunks larger than QImode. */
1431 static void
1432 emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
1433 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1435 rtx cmp_label, top_label, iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
1436 enum machine_mode x_addr_mode = get_address_mode (x);
1437 enum machine_mode y_addr_mode = get_address_mode (y);
1438 enum machine_mode iter_mode;
1440 iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
1441 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
1442 iter_mode = word_mode;
1444 top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1445 cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1446 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
1448 emit_move_insn (iter, const0_rtx);
1450 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
1451 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
1452 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
1454 emit_jump (cmp_label);
1455 emit_label (top_label);
1457 tmp = convert_modes (x_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1458 x_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, x_addr_mode, x_addr, tmp);
1460 if (x_addr_mode != y_addr_mode)
1461 tmp = convert_modes (y_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1462 y_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, y_addr_mode, y_addr, tmp);
1464 x = change_address (x, QImode, x_addr);
1465 y = change_address (y, QImode, y_addr);
1467 emit_move_insn (x, y);
1469 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, const1_rtx, iter,
1470 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1471 if (tmp != iter)
1472 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
1474 emit_label (cmp_label);
1476 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, size, LT, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
1477 true, top_label, REG_BR_PROB_BASE * 90 / 100);
1480 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
1481 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1483 void
1484 move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, enum machine_mode mode)
1486 int i;
1487 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1488 rtx pat;
1489 rtx last;
1490 #endif
1492 if (nregs == 0)
1493 return;
1495 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
1496 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
1498 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
1499 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1500 if (HAVE_load_multiple)
1502 last = get_last_insn ();
1503 pat = gen_load_multiple (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno), x,
1504 GEN_INT (nregs));
1505 if (pat)
1507 emit_insn (pat);
1508 return;
1510 else
1511 delete_insns_since (last);
1513 #endif
1515 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1516 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
1517 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
1520 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
1521 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1523 void
1524 move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
1526 int i;
1528 if (nregs == 0)
1529 return;
1531 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
1532 #ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
1533 if (HAVE_store_multiple)
1535 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
1536 rtx pat = gen_store_multiple (x, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
1537 GEN_INT (nregs));
1538 if (pat)
1540 emit_insn (pat);
1541 return;
1543 else
1544 delete_insns_since (last);
1546 #endif
1548 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1550 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
1552 gcc_assert (tem);
1554 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
1558 /* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
1559 ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
1560 a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
1561 original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
1562 The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
1565 gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
1567 int i, length;
1568 rtx *tmps;
1570 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (orig) == PARALLEL);
1572 length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
1573 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, length);
1575 /* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
1576 i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
1578 if (i)
1579 tmps[0] = 0;
1581 for (; i < length; i++)
1583 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
1584 rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
1586 tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
1589 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
1592 /* A subroutine of emit_group_load. Arguments as for emit_group_load,
1593 except that values are placed in TMPS[i], and must later be moved
1594 into corresponding XEXP (XVECEXP (DST, 0, i), 0) element. */
1596 static void
1597 emit_group_load_1 (rtx *tmps, rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type, int ssize)
1599 rtx src;
1600 int start, i;
1601 enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_src);
1603 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL);
1605 if (m != VOIDmode
1606 && !SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1607 && !MEM_P (orig_src)
1608 && GET_CODE (orig_src) != CONCAT)
1610 enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1611 if (imode == BLKmode)
1612 src = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_src), ssize);
1613 else
1614 src = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1615 if (imode != BLKmode)
1616 src = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_src), src);
1617 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1618 /* ...and back again. */
1619 if (imode != BLKmode)
1620 src = gen_lowpart (imode, src);
1621 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1622 return;
1625 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1626 both on the stack and in registers. */
1627 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
1628 start = 0;
1629 else
1630 start = 1;
1632 /* Process the pieces. */
1633 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1635 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
1636 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
1637 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1638 int shift = 0;
1640 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
1641 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
1643 /* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
1644 extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
1645 if (
1646 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
1647 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
1648 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
1649 #else
1650 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
1651 #endif
1653 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1654 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
1655 gcc_assert (bytelen > 0);
1658 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
1659 from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
1660 be loaded directly into the destination. */
1661 src = orig_src;
1662 if (!MEM_P (orig_src)
1663 && (!CONSTANT_P (orig_src)
1664 || (GET_MODE (orig_src) != mode
1665 && GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode)))
1667 if (GET_MODE (orig_src) == VOIDmode)
1668 src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1669 else
1670 src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1672 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1675 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
1676 if (MEM_P (src)
1677 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
1678 || MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1679 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
1680 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1682 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1683 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
1685 else if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode)
1686 && GET_MODE (src) == mode
1687 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1688 /* Let emit_move_complex do the bulk of the work. */
1689 tmps[i] = src;
1690 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
1692 unsigned int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1693 unsigned int slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
1695 if ((bytepos == 0 && bytelen == slen0)
1696 || (bytepos != 0 && bytepos + bytelen <= slen))
1698 /* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
1699 have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
1700 can be used to determine the object and the bit field
1701 to be extracted. */
1702 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, bytepos / slen0);
1703 if (! CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
1704 && (!REG_P (tmps[i]) || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode))
1705 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1706 (bytepos % slen0) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1707 1, false, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1709 else
1711 rtx mem;
1713 gcc_assert (!bytepos);
1714 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen);
1715 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1716 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (mem, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1717 0, 1, false, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1720 /* FIXME: A SIMD parallel will eventually lead to a subreg of a
1721 SIMD register, which is currently broken. While we get GCC
1722 to emit proper RTL for these cases, let's dump to memory. */
1723 else if (VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dst))
1724 && REG_P (src))
1726 int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1727 rtx mem;
1729 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen);
1730 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1731 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, (int) bytepos);
1733 else if (CONSTANT_P (src) && GET_MODE (dst) != BLKmode
1734 && XVECLEN (dst, 0) > 1)
1735 tmps[i] = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, src, GET_MODE(dst), bytepos);
1736 else if (CONSTANT_P (src))
1738 HOST_WIDE_INT len = (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen;
1740 if (len == ssize)
1741 tmps[i] = src;
1742 else
1744 rtx first, second;
1746 gcc_assert (2 * len == ssize);
1747 split_double (src, &first, &second);
1748 if (i)
1749 tmps[i] = second;
1750 else
1751 tmps[i] = first;
1754 else if (REG_P (src) && GET_MODE (src) == mode)
1755 tmps[i] = src;
1756 else
1757 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1758 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, false, NULL_RTX,
1759 mode, mode);
1761 if (shift)
1762 tmps[i] = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
1763 shift, tmps[i], 0);
1767 /* Emit code to move a block SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
1768 where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1769 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
1770 if not known. */
1772 void
1773 emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1775 rtx *tmps;
1776 int i;
1778 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1779 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1781 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
1782 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1784 rtx d = XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0);
1785 if (d == NULL)
1786 continue;
1787 emit_move_insn (d, tmps[i]);
1791 /* Similar, but load SRC into new pseudos in a format that looks like
1792 PARALLEL. This can later be fed to emit_group_move to get things
1793 in the right place. */
1796 emit_group_load_into_temps (rtx parallel, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1798 rtvec vec;
1799 int i;
1801 vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (parallel, 0));
1802 emit_group_load_1 (&RTVEC_ELT (vec, 0), parallel, src, type, ssize);
1804 /* Convert the vector to look just like the original PARALLEL, except
1805 with the computed values. */
1806 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (parallel, 0); i++)
1808 rtx e = XVECEXP (parallel, 0, i);
1809 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1811 if (d)
1813 d = force_reg (GET_MODE (d), RTVEC_ELT (vec, i));
1814 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), d, XEXP (e, 1));
1816 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1819 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (parallel), vec);
1822 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
1823 non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
1825 void
1826 emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
1828 int i;
1830 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL
1831 && GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL
1832 && XVECLEN (src, 0) == XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1834 /* Skip first entry if NULL. */
1835 for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1836 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
1837 XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
1840 /* Move a group of registers represented by a PARALLEL into pseudos. */
1843 emit_group_move_into_temps (rtx src)
1845 rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (src, 0));
1846 int i;
1848 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1850 rtx e = XVECEXP (src, 0, i);
1851 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1853 if (d)
1854 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), copy_to_reg (d), XEXP (e, 1));
1855 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1858 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (src), vec);
1861 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
1862 where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1863 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
1864 known. */
1866 void
1867 emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
1869 rtx *tmps, dst;
1870 int start, finish, i;
1871 enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_dst);
1873 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL);
1875 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1876 && !MEM_P (orig_dst) && GET_CODE (orig_dst) != CONCAT)
1878 enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_dst));
1879 if (imode == BLKmode)
1880 dst = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_dst), ssize);
1881 else
1882 dst = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1883 emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
1884 if (imode != BLKmode)
1885 dst = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_dst), dst);
1886 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
1887 return;
1890 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1891 both on the stack and in registers. */
1892 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
1893 start = 0;
1894 else
1895 start = 1;
1896 finish = XVECLEN (src, 0);
1898 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, finish);
1900 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
1901 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
1903 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
1904 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1906 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
1907 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
1909 else
1910 tmps[i] = reg;
1913 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
1914 from strange tricks we might play. */
1915 dst = orig_dst;
1916 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
1918 rtx temp;
1920 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
1921 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
1922 so no action is necessary. */
1923 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
1924 return;
1926 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
1927 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
1928 the temporary. */
1930 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize);
1931 emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
1932 emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
1933 return;
1935 else if (!MEM_P (dst) && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
1937 enum machine_mode outer = GET_MODE (dst);
1938 enum machine_mode inner;
1939 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos;
1940 bool done = false;
1941 rtx temp;
1943 if (!REG_P (dst) || REGNO (dst) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1944 dst = gen_reg_rtx (outer);
1946 /* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
1947 /* If the first element of the vector is the low part
1948 of the destination mode, use a paradoxical subreg to
1949 initialize the destination. */
1950 if (start < finish)
1952 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[start]);
1953 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
1954 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, start), 1)) == bytepos)
1956 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[start],
1957 inner, 0);
1958 if (temp)
1960 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
1961 done = true;
1962 start++;
1967 /* If the first element wasn't the low part, try the last. */
1968 if (!done
1969 && start < finish - 1)
1971 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[finish - 1]);
1972 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
1973 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, finish - 1), 1)) == bytepos)
1975 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[finish - 1],
1976 inner, 0);
1977 if (temp)
1979 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
1980 done = true;
1981 finish--;
1986 /* Otherwise, simply initialize the result to zero. */
1987 if (!done)
1988 emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (outer));
1991 /* Process the pieces. */
1992 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
1994 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
1995 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
1996 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1997 unsigned int adj_bytelen = bytelen;
1998 rtx dest = dst;
2000 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2001 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2002 adj_bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2004 if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
2006 if (bytepos + adj_bytelen
2007 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2008 dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
2009 else if (bytepos >= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2011 bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
2012 dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
2014 else
2016 enum machine_mode dest_mode = GET_MODE (dest);
2017 enum machine_mode tmp_mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2019 gcc_assert (bytepos == 0 && XVECLEN (src, 0));
2021 if (GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (dest_mode)
2022 >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmp_mode))
2024 dest = assign_stack_temp (dest_mode,
2025 GET_MODE_SIZE (dest_mode));
2026 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest,
2027 tmp_mode,
2028 bytepos),
2029 tmps[i]);
2030 dst = dest;
2032 else
2034 dest = assign_stack_temp (tmp_mode,
2035 GET_MODE_SIZE (tmp_mode));
2036 emit_move_insn (dest, tmps[i]);
2037 dst = adjust_address (dest, dest_mode, bytepos);
2039 break;
2043 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2045 /* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
2046 Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
2047 if (
2048 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2049 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
2050 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
2051 #else
2052 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2053 #endif
2056 int shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2057 tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
2058 shift, tmps[i], 0);
2060 bytelen = adj_bytelen;
2063 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2064 if (MEM_P (dest)
2065 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
2066 || MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2067 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
2068 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2069 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
2070 else
2071 store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2072 0, 0, mode, tmps[i]);
2075 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
2076 if (orig_dst != dst)
2077 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
2080 /* Return a form of X that does not use a PARALLEL. TYPE is the type
2081 of the value stored in X. */
2084 maybe_emit_group_store (rtx x, tree type)
2086 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
2087 gcc_checking_assert (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode || GET_MODE (x) == mode);
2088 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
2090 rtx result = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2091 emit_group_store (result, x, type, int_size_in_bytes (type));
2092 return result;
2094 return x;
2097 /* Copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a register SRCREG into TARGET.
2099 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
2101 void
2102 copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx target, rtx srcreg, tree type)
2104 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2105 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
2106 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
2107 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0;
2108 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (srcreg);
2109 enum machine_mode tmode = GET_MODE (target);
2110 enum machine_mode copy_mode;
2112 /* BLKmode registers created in the back-end shouldn't have survived. */
2113 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
2115 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see whether
2116 SRCREG is padded on the left or on the right. If it's on the left,
2117 set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of bits to skip.
2119 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2120 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2121 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2122 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2123 end of the register. */
2124 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2125 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (type)
2126 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2127 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2128 padding_correction
2129 = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2131 /* We can use a single move if we have an exact mode for the size. */
2132 else if (MEM_P (target)
2133 && (!SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target))
2134 || MEM_ALIGN (target) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2135 && bytes == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2137 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (target, mode, 0), srcreg);
2138 return;
2141 /* And if we additionally have the same mode for a register. */
2142 else if (REG_P (target)
2143 && GET_MODE (target) == mode
2144 && bytes == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2146 emit_move_insn (target, srcreg);
2147 return;
2150 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
2151 into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
2152 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
2154 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
2155 mode = word_mode;
2158 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. If the target lives in
2159 memory, take care of not reading/writing past its end by selecting
2160 a copy mode suited to BITSIZE. This should always be possible given
2161 how it is computed.
2163 If the target lives in register, make sure not to select a copy mode
2164 larger than the mode of the register.
2166 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
2167 strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
2168 time. */
2170 copy_mode = word_mode;
2171 if (MEM_P (target))
2173 enum machine_mode mem_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
2174 if (mem_mode != BLKmode)
2175 copy_mode = mem_mode;
2177 else if (REG_P (target) && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
2178 copy_mode = tmode;
2180 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2181 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2182 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2184 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
2185 word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2186 (the first time through). */
2187 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2188 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, mode);
2190 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
2191 a word boundary. */
2192 if (REG_P (target) && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
2193 dst = target;
2194 else if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2195 dst = operand_subword (target, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, tmode);
2197 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
2198 bitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
2199 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 0, 0, copy_mode,
2200 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
2201 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1, false,
2202 NULL_RTX, copy_mode, copy_mode));
2206 /* Copy BLKmode value SRC into a register of mode MODE. Return the
2207 register if it contains any data, otherwise return null.
2209 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
2212 copy_blkmode_to_reg (enum machine_mode mode, tree src)
2214 int i, n_regs;
2215 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0, bytes;
2216 unsigned int bitsize;
2217 rtx *dst_words, dst, x, src_word = NULL_RTX, dst_word = NULL_RTX;
2218 enum machine_mode dst_mode;
2220 gcc_assert (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) == BLKmode);
2222 x = expand_normal (src);
2224 bytes = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (src));
2225 if (bytes == 0)
2226 return NULL_RTX;
2228 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see
2229 whether the register value should be padded on the left or on
2230 the right. Set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of padding
2231 bits needed on the left side.
2233 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2234 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2235 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2236 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2237 end of the register. */
2238 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2239 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (TREE_TYPE (src))
2240 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2241 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2242 padding_correction = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD)
2243 * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2245 n_regs = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
2246 dst_words = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, n_regs);
2247 bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (src)), BITS_PER_WORD);
2249 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. */
2250 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2251 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2252 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2254 /* We need a new destination pseudo each time xbitpos is
2255 on a word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2256 (the first time through). */
2257 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2258 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2260 /* Generate an appropriate register. */
2261 dst_word = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
2262 dst_words[xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD] = dst_word;
2264 /* Clear the destination before we move anything into it. */
2265 emit_move_insn (dst_word, CONST0_RTX (word_mode));
2268 /* We need a new source operand each time bitpos is on a word
2269 boundary. */
2270 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2271 src_word = operand_subword_force (x, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, BLKmode);
2273 /* Use bitpos for the source extraction (left justified) and
2274 xbitpos for the destination store (right justified). */
2275 store_bit_field (dst_word, bitsize, xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD,
2276 0, 0, word_mode,
2277 extract_bit_field (src_word, bitsize,
2278 bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1, false,
2279 NULL_RTX, word_mode, word_mode));
2282 if (mode == BLKmode)
2284 /* Find the smallest integer mode large enough to hold the
2285 entire structure. */
2286 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2287 mode != VOIDmode;
2288 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2289 /* Have we found a large enough mode? */
2290 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= bytes)
2291 break;
2293 /* A suitable mode should have been found. */
2294 gcc_assert (mode != VOIDmode);
2297 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
2298 dst_mode = word_mode;
2299 else
2300 dst_mode = mode;
2301 dst = gen_reg_rtx (dst_mode);
2303 for (i = 0; i < n_regs; i++)
2304 emit_move_insn (operand_subword (dst, i, 0, dst_mode), dst_words[i]);
2306 if (mode != dst_mode)
2307 dst = gen_lowpart (mode, dst);
2309 return dst;
2312 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2313 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2315 void
2316 use_reg_mode (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg, enum machine_mode mode)
2318 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg) && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2320 *call_fusage
2321 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (mode, gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2324 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
2325 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
2327 void
2328 use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
2330 int i;
2332 gcc_assert (regno + nregs <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2334 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2335 use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
2338 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
2339 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
2340 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
2342 void
2343 use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
2345 int i;
2347 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
2349 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
2351 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
2352 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
2353 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
2354 if (reg != 0 && REG_P (reg))
2355 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
2359 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
2360 assigment and the code of the expresion on the RHS is CODE. Return
2361 NULL otherwise. */
2363 static gimple
2364 get_def_for_expr (tree name, enum tree_code code)
2366 gimple def_stmt;
2368 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
2369 return NULL;
2371 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
2372 if (!def_stmt
2373 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) != code)
2374 return NULL;
2376 return def_stmt;
2379 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
2380 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
2381 assigment and the class of the expresion on the RHS is CLASS. Return
2382 NULL otherwise. */
2384 static gimple
2385 get_def_for_expr_class (tree name, enum tree_code_class tclass)
2387 gimple def_stmt;
2389 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
2390 return NULL;
2392 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
2393 if (!def_stmt
2394 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt)) != tclass)
2395 return NULL;
2397 return def_stmt;
2399 #endif
2402 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
2403 stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
2404 a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2405 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2406 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2407 Return nonzero if a call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
2410 can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2411 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2412 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp)
2414 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
2415 unsigned int max_size;
2416 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
2417 enum machine_mode mode;
2418 enum insn_code icode;
2419 int reverse;
2420 /* cst is set but not used if LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT doesn't use it. */
2421 rtx cst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2423 if (len == 0)
2424 return 1;
2426 if (! (memsetp
2427 ? SET_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)
2428 : STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)))
2429 return 0;
2431 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
2433 /* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2434 successively smaller modes. */
2436 for (reverse = 0;
2437 reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
2438 reverse++)
2440 l = len;
2441 max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2442 while (max_size > 1 && l > 0)
2444 mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2446 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2447 break;
2449 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2450 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
2451 && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2453 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2455 while (l >= size)
2457 if (reverse)
2458 offset -= size;
2460 cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, offset, mode);
2461 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, cst))
2462 return 0;
2464 if (!reverse)
2465 offset += size;
2467 l -= size;
2471 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2474 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2475 gcc_assert (!l);
2478 return 1;
2481 /* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
2482 CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
2483 pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2484 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2485 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2486 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
2487 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
2488 stpcpy. */
2491 store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2492 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2493 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp, int endp)
2495 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode = get_address_mode (to);
2496 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2498 if (len == 0)
2500 gcc_assert (endp != 2);
2501 return to;
2504 gcc_assert (memsetp
2505 ? SET_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)
2506 : STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align));
2507 data.constfun = constfun;
2508 data.constfundata = constfundata;
2509 data.len = len;
2510 data.to = to;
2511 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2512 if (endp)
2514 rtx to1;
2516 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
2517 if (data.autinc_to)
2519 if (endp == 2)
2521 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
2522 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
2523 else
2524 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2525 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
2526 data.to_addr,
2527 -1));
2529 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
2530 data.offset);
2532 else
2534 if (endp == 2)
2535 --data.offset;
2536 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
2538 return to1;
2540 else
2541 return data.to;
2544 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2545 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2547 static void
2548 clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
2550 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2552 if (len == 0)
2553 return;
2555 data.constfun = clear_by_pieces_1;
2556 data.constfundata = NULL;
2557 data.len = len;
2558 data.to = to;
2559 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2562 /* Callback routine for clear_by_pieces.
2563 Return const0_rtx unconditionally. */
2565 static rtx
2566 clear_by_pieces_1 (void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2567 HOST_WIDE_INT offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2568 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2570 return const0_rtx;
2573 /* Subroutine of clear_by_pieces and store_by_pieces.
2574 Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2575 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2577 static void
2578 store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2579 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2581 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode = get_address_mode (data->to);
2582 rtx to_addr = XEXP (data->to, 0);
2583 unsigned int max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2584 enum insn_code icode;
2586 data->offset = 0;
2587 data->to_addr = to_addr;
2588 data->autinc_to
2589 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
2590 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2592 data->explicit_inc_to = 0;
2593 data->reverse
2594 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2595 if (data->reverse)
2596 data->offset = data->len;
2598 /* If storing requires more than two move insns,
2599 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
2600 and use post-increment if available. */
2601 if (!data->autinc_to
2602 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (data->len, align, max_size) > 2)
2604 /* Determine the main mode we'll be using.
2605 MODE might not be used depending on the definitions of the
2606 USE_* macros below. */
2607 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
2608 = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2610 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data->reverse && ! data->autinc_to)
2612 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2613 plus_constant (to_addr_mode,
2614 to_addr,
2615 data->len));
2616 data->autinc_to = 1;
2617 data->explicit_inc_to = -1;
2620 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data->reverse
2621 && ! data->autinc_to)
2623 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2624 data->autinc_to = 1;
2625 data->explicit_inc_to = 1;
2628 if ( !data->autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
2629 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2632 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
2634 /* First store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2635 successively smaller modes. */
2637 while (max_size > 1 && data->len > 0)
2639 enum machine_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2641 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2642 break;
2644 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2645 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2646 store_by_pieces_2 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, data);
2648 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2651 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2652 gcc_assert (!data->len);
2655 /* Subroutine of store_by_pieces_1. Store as many bytes as appropriate
2656 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
2657 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
2659 static void
2660 store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
2661 struct store_by_pieces_d *data)
2663 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2664 rtx to1, cst;
2666 while (data->len >= size)
2668 if (data->reverse)
2669 data->offset -= size;
2671 if (data->autinc_to)
2672 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
2673 data->offset);
2674 else
2675 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
2677 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
2678 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
2679 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size)));
2681 cst = (*data->constfun) (data->constfundata, data->offset, mode);
2682 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, cst));
2684 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
2685 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
2687 if (! data->reverse)
2688 data->offset += size;
2690 data->len -= size;
2694 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
2695 its length in bytes. */
2698 clear_storage_hints (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
2699 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
2701 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (object);
2702 unsigned int align;
2704 gcc_assert (method == BLOCK_OP_NORMAL || method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2706 /* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
2707 just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
2708 if (mode != BLKmode
2709 && CONST_INT_P (size)
2710 && INTVAL (size) == (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2712 rtx zero = CONST0_RTX (mode);
2713 if (zero != NULL)
2715 emit_move_insn (object, zero);
2716 return NULL;
2719 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
2721 zero = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
2722 if (zero != NULL)
2724 write_complex_part (object, zero, 0);
2725 write_complex_part (object, zero, 1);
2726 return NULL;
2731 if (size == const0_rtx)
2732 return NULL;
2734 align = MEM_ALIGN (object);
2736 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
2737 && CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
2738 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
2739 else if (set_storage_via_setmem (object, size, const0_rtx, align,
2740 expected_align, expected_size))
2742 else if (ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (object)))
2743 return set_storage_via_libcall (object, size, const0_rtx,
2744 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2745 else
2746 gcc_unreachable ();
2748 return NULL;
2752 clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
2754 return clear_storage_hints (object, size, method, 0, -1);
2758 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset.
2759 Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
2762 set_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, bool tailcall)
2764 tree call_expr, fn, object_tree, size_tree, val_tree;
2765 enum machine_mode size_mode;
2766 rtx retval;
2768 /* Emit code to copy OBJECT and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then
2769 place those into new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and use them later. */
2771 object = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (object, 0));
2773 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
2774 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
2775 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
2777 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
2778 memset in this context. This could be a user call to memset and
2779 the user may wish to examine the return value from memset. For
2780 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
2781 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
2783 object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
2784 if (!CONST_INT_P (val))
2785 val = convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), val, 1);
2786 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
2787 val_tree = make_tree (integer_type_node, val);
2789 fn = clear_storage_libcall_fn (true);
2790 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, object_tree, val_tree, size_tree);
2791 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
2793 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
2795 return retval;
2798 /* A subroutine of set_storage_via_libcall. Create the tree node
2799 for the function we use for block clears. */
2801 tree block_clear_fn;
2803 void
2804 init_block_clear_fn (const char *asmspec)
2806 if (!block_clear_fn)
2808 tree fn, args;
2810 fn = get_identifier ("memset");
2811 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
2812 integer_type_node, sizetype,
2813 NULL_TREE);
2815 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
2816 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
2817 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
2818 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
2819 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
2820 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
2821 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
2823 block_clear_fn = fn;
2826 if (asmspec)
2827 set_user_assembler_name (block_clear_fn, asmspec);
2830 static tree
2831 clear_storage_libcall_fn (int for_call)
2833 static bool emitted_extern;
2835 if (!block_clear_fn)
2836 init_block_clear_fn (NULL);
2838 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
2840 emitted_extern = true;
2841 make_decl_rtl (block_clear_fn);
2844 return block_clear_fn;
2847 /* Expand a setmem pattern; return true if successful. */
2849 bool
2850 set_storage_via_setmem (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, unsigned int align,
2851 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
2853 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
2854 including more than one in the machine description unless
2855 the more limited one has some advantage. */
2857 enum machine_mode mode;
2859 if (expected_align < align)
2860 expected_align = align;
2862 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
2863 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2865 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (setmem_optab, mode);
2867 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
2868 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than
2869 BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT here because if SIZE is less than
2870 the mode mask, as it is returned by the macro, it will
2871 definitely be less than the actual mode mask. */
2872 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
2873 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
2874 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
2875 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD))
2877 struct expand_operand ops[6];
2878 unsigned int nops;
2880 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
2881 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6);
2883 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], object);
2884 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
2885 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[1], size, mode, true);
2886 create_convert_operand_from (&ops[2], val, byte_mode, true);
2887 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2888 if (nops == 6)
2890 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2891 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
2893 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
2894 return true;
2898 return false;
2902 /* Write to one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Write VAL to
2903 the real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if its true. */
2905 static void
2906 write_complex_part (rtx cplx, rtx val, bool imag_p)
2908 enum machine_mode cmode;
2909 enum machine_mode imode;
2910 unsigned ibitsize;
2912 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
2914 emit_move_insn (XEXP (cplx, imag_p), val);
2915 return;
2918 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
2919 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
2920 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
2922 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
2923 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
2924 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
2925 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
2926 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
2927 if (MEM_P (cplx))
2929 emit_move_insn (adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
2930 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0),
2931 val);
2932 return;
2935 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
2936 will work. This special case is important, since store_bit_field
2937 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
2938 correspond to TCmode. */
2939 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
2940 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
2941 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
2942 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
2943 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
2944 || (REG_P (cplx)
2945 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2946 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
2948 rtx part = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
2949 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2950 if (part)
2952 emit_move_insn (part, val);
2953 return;
2955 else
2956 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
2957 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
2960 store_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0, 0, 0, imode, val);
2963 /* Extract one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Extract the
2964 real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if it's true. */
2966 static rtx
2967 read_complex_part (rtx cplx, bool imag_p)
2969 enum machine_mode cmode, imode;
2970 unsigned ibitsize;
2972 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
2973 return XEXP (cplx, imag_p);
2975 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
2976 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
2977 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
2979 /* Special case reads from complex constants that got spilled to memory. */
2980 if (MEM_P (cplx) && GET_CODE (XEXP (cplx, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
2982 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (cplx, 0));
2983 if (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) == COMPLEX_CST)
2985 tree part = imag_p ? TREE_IMAGPART (decl) : TREE_REALPART (decl);
2986 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (part))
2987 return expand_expr (part, NULL_RTX, imode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
2991 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
2992 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
2993 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
2994 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
2995 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
2996 if (MEM_P (cplx))
2997 return adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
2998 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
3000 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
3001 will work. This special case is important, since extract_bit_field
3002 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
3003 correspond to TCmode. */
3004 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
3005 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
3006 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
3007 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
3008 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
3009 || (REG_P (cplx)
3010 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3011 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
3013 rtx ret = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
3014 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
3015 if (ret)
3016 return ret;
3017 else
3018 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
3019 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
3022 return extract_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0,
3023 true, false, NULL_RTX, imode, imode);
3026 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Yet another lowpart generator.
3027 NEW_MODE and OLD_MODE are the same size. Return NULL if X cannot be
3028 represented in NEW_MODE. If FORCE is true, this will never happen, as
3029 we'll force-create a SUBREG if needed. */
3031 static rtx
3032 emit_move_change_mode (enum machine_mode new_mode,
3033 enum machine_mode old_mode, rtx x, bool force)
3035 rtx ret;
3037 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
3039 ret = gen_rtx_MEM (new_mode, XEXP (x, 0));
3040 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (ret, x);
3042 else if (MEM_P (x))
3044 /* We don't have to worry about changing the address since the
3045 size in bytes is supposed to be the same. */
3046 if (reload_in_progress)
3048 /* Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
3049 substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
3050 ret = adjust_address_nv (x, new_mode, 0);
3051 copy_replacements (x, ret);
3053 else
3054 ret = adjust_address (x, new_mode, 0);
3056 else
3058 /* Note that we do want simplify_subreg's behavior of validating
3059 that the new mode is ok for a hard register. If we were to use
3060 simplify_gen_subreg, we would create the subreg, but would
3061 probably run into the target not being able to implement it. */
3062 /* Except, of course, when FORCE is true, when this is exactly what
3063 we want. Which is needed for CCmodes on some targets. */
3064 if (force)
3065 ret = simplify_gen_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3066 else
3067 ret = simplify_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3070 return ret;
3073 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X using
3074 an integer mode of the same size as MODE. Returns the instruction
3075 emitted, or NULL if such a move could not be generated. */
3077 static rtx
3078 emit_move_via_integer (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y, bool force)
3080 enum machine_mode imode;
3081 enum insn_code code;
3083 /* There must exist a mode of the exact size we require. */
3084 imode = int_mode_for_mode (mode);
3085 if (imode == BLKmode)
3086 return NULL_RTX;
3088 /* The target must support moves in this mode. */
3089 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, imode);
3090 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3091 return NULL_RTX;
3093 x = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, x, force);
3094 if (x == NULL_RTX)
3095 return NULL_RTX;
3096 y = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, y, force);
3097 if (y == NULL_RTX)
3098 return NULL_RTX;
3099 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3102 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. X is a push_operand in MODE.
3103 Return an equivalent MEM that does not use an auto-increment. */
3105 static rtx
3106 emit_move_resolve_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
3108 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
3109 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust;
3110 rtx temp;
3112 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3113 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3114 adjust = PUSH_ROUNDING (adjust);
3115 #endif
3116 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
3117 adjust = -adjust;
3118 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
3120 rtx expr = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
3121 HOST_WIDE_INT val;
3123 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == PLUS || GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS);
3124 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (expr, 1)));
3125 val = INTVAL (XEXP (expr, 1));
3126 if (GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS)
3127 val = -val;
3128 gcc_assert (adjust == val || adjust == -val);
3129 adjust = val;
3132 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
3133 stack_pointer_delta. */
3134 temp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, stack_pointer_rtx,
3135 GEN_INT (adjust), stack_pointer_rtx,
3136 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3137 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
3138 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
3140 switch (code)
3142 case PRE_INC:
3143 case PRE_DEC:
3144 case PRE_MODIFY:
3145 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
3146 break;
3147 case POST_INC:
3148 case POST_DEC:
3149 case POST_MODIFY:
3150 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, -adjust);
3151 break;
3152 default:
3153 gcc_unreachable ();
3156 return replace_equiv_address (x, temp);
3159 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Generate a move from Y into X.
3160 X is known to satisfy push_operand, and MODE is known to be complex.
3161 Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3164 emit_move_complex_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3166 enum machine_mode submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
3167 bool imag_first;
3169 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3170 unsigned int submodesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
3172 /* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
3173 machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
3174 if (PUSH_ROUNDING (submodesize) != submodesize)
3176 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3177 return emit_move_insn (x, y);
3179 #endif
3181 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
3182 regardless of machine's endianness. */
3183 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
3185 case PRE_DEC:
3186 case POST_DEC:
3187 imag_first = true;
3188 break;
3189 case PRE_INC:
3190 case POST_INC:
3191 imag_first = false;
3192 break;
3193 default:
3194 gcc_unreachable ();
3197 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3198 read_complex_part (y, imag_first));
3199 return emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3200 read_complex_part (y, !imag_first));
3203 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Perform the move from Y to X
3204 via two moves of the parts. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3207 emit_move_complex_parts (rtx x, rtx y)
3209 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3210 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3211 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values. */
3212 if (!reload_completed && !reload_in_progress
3213 && REG_P (x) && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, y))
3214 emit_clobber (x);
3216 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, false), false);
3217 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, true), true);
3219 return get_last_insn ();
3222 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3223 MODE is known to be complex. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3225 static rtx
3226 emit_move_complex (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3228 bool try_int;
3230 /* Need to take special care for pushes, to maintain proper ordering
3231 of the data, and possibly extra padding. */
3232 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3233 return emit_move_complex_push (mode, x, y);
3235 /* See if we can coerce the target into moving both values at once. */
3237 /* Move floating point as parts. */
3238 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
3239 && optab_handler (mov_optab, GET_MODE_INNER (mode)) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3240 try_int = false;
3241 /* Not possible if the values are inherently not adjacent. */
3242 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (y) == CONCAT)
3243 try_int = false;
3244 /* Is possible if both are registers (or subregs of registers). */
3245 else if (register_operand (x, mode) && register_operand (y, mode))
3246 try_int = true;
3247 /* If one of the operands is a memory, and alignment constraints
3248 are friendly enough, we may be able to do combined memory operations.
3249 We do not attempt this if Y is a constant because that combination is
3250 usually better with the by-parts thing below. */
3251 else if ((MEM_P (x) ? !CONSTANT_P (y) : MEM_P (y))
3252 && (!STRICT_ALIGNMENT
3253 || get_mode_alignment (mode) == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT))
3254 try_int = true;
3255 else
3256 try_int = false;
3258 if (try_int)
3260 rtx ret;
3262 /* For memory to memory moves, optimal behavior can be had with the
3263 existing block move logic. */
3264 if (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y))
3266 emit_block_move (x, y, GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
3267 BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL);
3268 return get_last_insn ();
3271 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3272 if (ret)
3273 return ret;
3276 return emit_move_complex_parts (x, y);
3279 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3280 MODE is known to be MODE_CC. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3282 static rtx
3283 emit_move_ccmode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3285 rtx ret;
3287 /* Assume all MODE_CC modes are equivalent; if we have movcc, use it. */
3288 if (mode != CCmode)
3290 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (mov_optab, CCmode);
3291 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3293 x = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, x, true);
3294 y = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, y, true);
3295 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3299 /* Otherwise, find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
3300 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
3301 gcc_assert (ret != NULL);
3302 return ret;
3305 /* Return true if word I of OP lies entirely in the
3306 undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3308 static bool
3309 undefined_operand_subword_p (const_rtx op, int i)
3311 enum machine_mode innermode, innermostmode;
3312 int offset;
3313 if (GET_CODE (op) != SUBREG)
3314 return false;
3315 innermode = GET_MODE (op);
3316 innermostmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op));
3317 offset = i * UNITS_PER_WORD + SUBREG_BYTE (op);
3318 /* The SUBREG_BYTE represents offset, as if the value were stored in
3319 memory, except for a paradoxical subreg where we define
3320 SUBREG_BYTE to be 0; undo this exception as in
3321 simplify_subreg. */
3322 if (SUBREG_BYTE (op) == 0
3323 && GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode))
3325 int difference = (GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) - GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode));
3326 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
3327 offset += (difference / UNITS_PER_WORD) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3328 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
3329 offset += difference % UNITS_PER_WORD;
3331 if (offset >= GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode)
3332 || offset <= -GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
3333 return true;
3334 return false;
3337 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3338 MODE is any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
3339 pattern. Note that you will get better code if you define such
3340 patterns, even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
3342 static rtx
3343 emit_move_multi_word (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3345 rtx last_insn = 0;
3346 rtx seq, inner;
3347 bool need_clobber;
3348 int i;
3350 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= UNITS_PER_WORD);
3352 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
3353 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
3354 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3355 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3357 /* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
3358 is scheduled for replacement. */
3359 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (x)
3360 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
3361 x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
3362 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (y)
3363 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
3364 y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
3366 start_sequence ();
3368 need_clobber = false;
3369 for (i = 0;
3370 i < (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3371 i++)
3373 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
3374 rtx ypart;
3376 /* Do not generate code for a move if it would come entirely
3377 from the undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3378 if (undefined_operand_subword_p (y, i))
3379 continue;
3381 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3383 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
3384 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. Then we must
3385 be able to get a part of Y. */
3386 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
3388 y = use_anchored_address (force_const_mem (mode, y));
3389 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3391 else if (ypart == 0)
3392 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
3394 gcc_assert (xpart && ypart);
3396 need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
3398 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
3401 seq = get_insns ();
3402 end_sequence ();
3404 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3405 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3406 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
3407 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
3408 if (x != y
3409 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3410 && need_clobber != 0)
3411 emit_clobber (x);
3413 emit_insn (seq);
3415 return last_insn;
3418 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
3419 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
3420 are basically valid. */
3423 emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
3425 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3426 enum insn_code code;
3428 gcc_assert ((unsigned int) mode < (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE);
3430 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
3431 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3432 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3434 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part. */
3435 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
3436 return emit_move_complex (mode, x, y);
3438 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_DECIMAL_FLOAT
3439 || ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
3441 rtx result = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3443 /* If we can't find an integer mode, use multi words. */
3444 if (result)
3445 return result;
3446 else
3447 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3450 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC)
3451 return emit_move_ccmode (mode, x, y);
3453 /* Try using a move pattern for the corresponding integer mode. This is
3454 only safe when simplify_subreg can convert MODE constants into integer
3455 constants. At present, it can only do this reliably if the value
3456 fits within a HOST_WIDE_INT. */
3457 if (!CONSTANT_P (y) || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
3459 rtx ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, lra_in_progress);
3461 if (ret)
3463 if (! lra_in_progress || recog (PATTERN (ret), ret, 0) >= 0)
3464 return ret;
3468 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3471 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
3472 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
3473 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
3474 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
3476 Return the last instruction emitted. */
3479 emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
3481 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3482 rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
3483 rtx last_insn, set;
3485 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode
3486 && (GET_MODE (y) == mode || GET_MODE (y) == VOIDmode));
3488 if (CONSTANT_P (y))
3490 if (optimize
3491 && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
3492 && (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
3493 return last_insn;
3495 y_cst = y;
3497 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, y))
3499 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
3501 /* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
3502 assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
3503 of the non-legitimate constant. */
3504 if (!y)
3505 y = y_cst;
3506 else
3507 y = use_anchored_address (y);
3511 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
3512 for the machine. */
3513 if (MEM_P (x)
3514 && (! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
3515 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
3516 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x))))
3517 x = validize_mem (x);
3519 if (MEM_P (y)
3520 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0),
3521 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
3522 y = validize_mem (y);
3524 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
3526 last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
3528 if (y_cst && REG_P (x)
3529 && (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
3530 && SET_DEST (set) == x
3531 && ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
3532 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, copy_rtx (y_cst));
3534 return last_insn;
3537 /* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
3538 perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
3539 move as an extension. */
3541 static rtx
3542 compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
3544 enum machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
3545 enum machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
3546 enum machine_mode srcmode;
3547 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
3548 int oldcost, newcost;
3549 bool speed = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
3551 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, y);
3553 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (dstmode, y))
3554 oldcost = set_src_cost (y, speed);
3555 else
3556 oldcost = set_src_cost (force_const_mem (dstmode, y), speed);
3558 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (GET_MODE_CLASS (orig_srcmode));
3559 srcmode != orig_srcmode;
3560 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
3562 enum insn_code ic;
3563 rtx trunc_y, last_insn;
3565 /* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
3566 ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
3567 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3568 continue;
3570 /* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
3571 if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, &r))
3572 continue;
3574 trunc_y = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (r, srcmode);
3576 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (srcmode, trunc_y))
3578 /* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
3579 the extension. */
3580 if (!insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, trunc_y))
3581 continue;
3582 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3583 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3584 speed);
3585 if (oldcost < newcost)
3586 continue;
3588 else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
3590 trunc_y = force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y);
3591 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3592 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3593 speed);
3594 if (oldcost < newcost)
3595 continue;
3596 trunc_y = validize_mem (trunc_y);
3598 else
3599 continue;
3601 /* For CSE's benefit, force the compressed constant pool entry
3602 into a new pseudo. This constant may be used in different modes,
3603 and if not, combine will put things back together for us. */
3604 trunc_y = force_reg (srcmode, trunc_y);
3605 emit_unop_insn (ic, x, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
3606 last_insn = get_last_insn ();
3608 if (REG_P (x))
3609 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
3611 return last_insn;
3614 return NULL_RTX;
3617 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
3619 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
3620 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
3621 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
3623 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
3624 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
3625 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
3628 push_block (rtx size, int extra, int below)
3630 rtx temp;
3632 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
3633 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
3634 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (Pmode, size, extra));
3635 else if (REG_P (size) && extra == 0)
3636 anti_adjust_stack (size);
3637 else
3639 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
3640 if (extra != 0)
3641 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (extra),
3642 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3643 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
3646 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3647 if (0)
3648 #else
3649 if (1)
3650 #endif
3652 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
3653 if (extra != 0 && below)
3654 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, temp, extra);
3656 else
3658 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
3659 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3660 -INTVAL (size) - (below ? 0 : extra));
3661 else if (extra != 0 && !below)
3662 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3663 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (Pmode, size,
3664 extra)));
3665 else
3666 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3667 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
3670 return memory_address (GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), temp);
3673 /* A utility routine that returns the base of an auto-inc memory, or NULL. */
3675 static rtx
3676 mem_autoinc_base (rtx mem)
3678 if (MEM_P (mem))
3680 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
3681 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (addr)) == RTX_AUTOINC)
3682 return XEXP (addr, 0);
3684 return NULL;
3687 /* A utility routine used here, in reload, and in try_split. The insns
3688 after PREV up to and including LAST are known to adjust the stack,
3689 with a final value of END_ARGS_SIZE. Iterate backward from LAST
3690 placing notes as appropriate. PREV may be NULL, indicating the
3691 entire insn sequence prior to LAST should be scanned.
3693 The set of allowed stack pointer modifications is small:
3694 (1) One or more auto-inc style memory references (aka pushes),
3695 (2) One or more addition/subtraction with the SP as destination,
3696 (3) A single move insn with the SP as destination,
3697 (4) A call_pop insn,
3698 (5) Noreturn call insns if !ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS.
3700 Insns in the sequence that do not modify the SP are ignored,
3701 except for noreturn calls.
3703 The return value is the amount of adjustment that can be trivially
3704 verified, via immediate operand or auto-inc. If the adjustment
3705 cannot be trivially extracted, the return value is INT_MIN. */
3707 HOST_WIDE_INT
3708 find_args_size_adjust (rtx insn)
3710 rtx dest, set, pat;
3711 int i;
3713 pat = PATTERN (insn);
3714 set = NULL;
3716 /* Look for a call_pop pattern. */
3717 if (CALL_P (insn))
3719 /* We have to allow non-call_pop patterns for the case
3720 of emit_single_push_insn of a TLS address. */
3721 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
3722 return 0;
3724 /* All call_pop have a stack pointer adjust in the parallel.
3725 The call itself is always first, and the stack adjust is
3726 usually last, so search from the end. */
3727 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i > 0; --i)
3729 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
3730 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
3731 continue;
3732 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3733 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
3734 break;
3736 /* We'd better have found the stack pointer adjust. */
3737 if (i == 0)
3738 return 0;
3739 /* Fall through to process the extracted SET and DEST
3740 as if it was a standalone insn. */
3742 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET)
3743 set = pat;
3744 else if ((set = single_set (insn)) != NULL)
3746 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
3748 /* ??? Some older ports use a parallel with a stack adjust
3749 and a store for a PUSH_ROUNDING pattern, rather than a
3750 PRE/POST_MODIFY rtx. Don't force them to update yet... */
3751 /* ??? See h8300 and m68k, pushqi1. */
3752 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3754 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
3755 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
3756 continue;
3757 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3758 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
3759 break;
3761 /* We do not expect an auto-inc of the sp in the parallel. */
3762 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (dest) != stack_pointer_rtx);
3763 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
3764 != stack_pointer_rtx);
3766 if (i < 0)
3767 return 0;
3769 else
3770 return 0;
3772 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3774 /* Look for direct modifications of the stack pointer. */
3775 if (REG_P (dest) && REGNO (dest) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
3777 /* Look for a trivial adjustment, otherwise assume nothing. */
3778 /* Note that the SPU restore_stack_block pattern refers to
3779 the stack pointer in V4SImode. Consider that non-trivial. */
3780 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dest))
3781 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
3782 && XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
3783 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)))
3784 return INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1));
3785 /* ??? Reload can generate no-op moves, which will be cleaned
3786 up later. Recognize it and continue searching. */
3787 else if (rtx_equal_p (dest, SET_SRC (set)))
3788 return 0;
3789 else
3790 return HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN;
3792 else
3794 rtx mem, addr;
3796 /* Otherwise only think about autoinc patterns. */
3797 if (mem_autoinc_base (dest) == stack_pointer_rtx)
3799 mem = dest;
3800 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
3801 != stack_pointer_rtx);
3803 else if (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set)) == stack_pointer_rtx)
3804 mem = SET_SRC (set);
3805 else
3806 return 0;
3808 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
3809 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
3811 case PRE_INC:
3812 case POST_INC:
3813 return GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
3814 case PRE_DEC:
3815 case POST_DEC:
3816 return -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
3817 case PRE_MODIFY:
3818 case POST_MODIFY:
3819 addr = XEXP (addr, 1);
3820 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS);
3821 gcc_assert (XEXP (addr, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
3822 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (addr, 1)));
3823 return INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1));
3824 default:
3825 gcc_unreachable ();
3831 fixup_args_size_notes (rtx prev, rtx last, int end_args_size)
3833 int args_size = end_args_size;
3834 bool saw_unknown = false;
3835 rtx insn;
3837 for (insn = last; insn != prev; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
3839 HOST_WIDE_INT this_delta;
3841 if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
3842 continue;
3844 this_delta = find_args_size_adjust (insn);
3845 if (this_delta == 0)
3847 if (!CALL_P (insn)
3848 || ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3849 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_NORETURN, NULL_RTX) == NULL_RTX)
3850 continue;
3853 gcc_assert (!saw_unknown);
3854 if (this_delta == HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN)
3855 saw_unknown = true;
3857 add_reg_note (insn, REG_ARGS_SIZE, GEN_INT (args_size));
3858 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3859 this_delta = -(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) this_delta;
3860 #endif
3861 args_size -= this_delta;
3864 return saw_unknown ? INT_MIN : args_size;
3867 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3868 /* Emit single push insn. */
3870 static void
3871 emit_single_push_insn_1 (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
3873 rtx dest_addr;
3874 unsigned rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3875 rtx dest;
3876 enum insn_code icode;
3878 stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3879 /* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
3880 MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
3881 icode = optab_handler (push_optab, mode);
3882 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3884 struct expand_operand ops[1];
3886 create_input_operand (&ops[0], x, mode);
3887 if (maybe_expand_insn (icode, 1, ops))
3888 return;
3890 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == rounded_size)
3891 dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
3892 /* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
3893 then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
3894 because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
3895 access to type. */
3896 else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type) == downward)
3898 unsigned padding_size = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3899 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
3901 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
3902 expand_binop (Pmode,
3903 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3904 sub_optab,
3905 #else
3906 add_optab,
3907 #endif
3908 stack_pointer_rtx,
3909 GEN_INT (rounded_size),
3910 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
3912 offset = (HOST_WIDE_INT) padding_size;
3913 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3914 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3915 /* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
3916 previous value. */
3917 offset += (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3918 #else
3919 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
3920 /* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
3921 previous value. */
3922 offset -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3923 #endif
3924 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (offset));
3926 else
3928 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3929 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
3930 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3931 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size));
3932 #else
3933 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
3934 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3935 GEN_INT (rounded_size));
3936 #endif
3937 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
3940 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
3942 if (type != 0)
3944 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
3946 if (flag_optimize_sibling_calls)
3947 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
3948 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
3949 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
3950 of sibling calls. */
3951 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
3953 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
3956 /* Emit and annotate a single push insn. */
3958 static void
3959 emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
3961 int delta, old_delta = stack_pointer_delta;
3962 rtx prev = get_last_insn ();
3963 rtx last;
3965 emit_single_push_insn_1 (mode, x, type);
3967 last = get_last_insn ();
3969 /* Notice the common case where we emitted exactly one insn. */
3970 if (PREV_INSN (last) == prev)
3972 add_reg_note (last, REG_ARGS_SIZE, GEN_INT (stack_pointer_delta));
3973 return;
3976 delta = fixup_args_size_notes (prev, last, stack_pointer_delta);
3977 gcc_assert (delta == INT_MIN || delta == old_delta);
3979 #endif
3981 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
3982 type TYPE.
3983 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
3984 carry mode info).
3985 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
3986 needed only if X is BLKmode.
3988 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
3990 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
3991 bytes of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
3992 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL bytes.
3993 REG must be a hard register in this case.
3994 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
3995 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
3996 registers.
3998 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
3999 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
4001 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
4002 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
4003 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
4004 argument block has not been preallocated.
4006 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
4008 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
4009 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
4010 of bytes required. */
4012 void
4013 emit_push_insn (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
4014 unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, int extra,
4015 rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
4016 rtx alignment_pad)
4018 rtx xinner;
4019 enum direction stack_direction
4020 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
4021 = downward;
4022 #else
4023 = upward;
4024 #endif
4026 /* Decide where to pad the argument: `downward' for below,
4027 `upward' for above, or `none' for don't pad it.
4028 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
4029 enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type);
4031 /* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
4032 FIXME: why? */
4033 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
4034 if (where_pad != none)
4035 where_pad = (where_pad == downward ? upward : downward);
4037 xinner = x;
4039 if (mode == BLKmode
4040 || (STRICT_ALIGNMENT && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
4042 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
4044 rtx temp;
4045 int used;
4046 int offset;
4047 int skip;
4049 offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4050 used = partial - offset;
4052 if (mode != BLKmode)
4054 /* A value is to be stored in an insufficiently aligned
4055 stack slot; copy via a suitably aligned slot if
4056 necessary. */
4057 size = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4058 if (!MEM_P (xinner))
4060 temp = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
4061 emit_move_insn (temp, xinner);
4062 xinner = temp;
4066 gcc_assert (size);
4068 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
4069 because registers will take care of them. */
4071 if (partial != 0)
4072 xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
4074 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4075 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4076 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4077 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4078 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
4080 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4081 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
4082 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
4083 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
4084 if (args_addr == 0
4085 && PUSH_ARGS
4086 && CONST_INT_P (size)
4087 && skip == 0
4088 && MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
4089 && (MOVE_BY_PIECES_P ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align))
4090 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
4091 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
4092 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
4093 && ((! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align))
4094 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
4095 || (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
4096 == (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)))
4097 && (HOST_WIDE_INT) PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)) == INTVAL (size))
4099 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4100 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4101 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4102 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4103 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4104 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4106 move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align, 0);
4108 else
4109 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
4111 rtx target;
4113 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
4114 to the address of that space. */
4116 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
4117 if (partial != 0)
4119 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
4120 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
4121 else
4122 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
4123 GEN_INT (used), NULL_RTX, 0,
4124 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4127 /* Get the address of the stack space.
4128 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
4129 A single stack adjust will do. */
4130 if (! args_addr)
4132 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == downward);
4133 extra = 0;
4135 else if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
4136 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4137 plus_constant (Pmode, args_addr,
4138 skip + INTVAL (args_so_far)));
4139 else
4140 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4141 plus_constant (Pmode,
4142 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
4143 args_addr,
4144 args_so_far),
4145 skip));
4147 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
4149 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
4150 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
4151 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
4153 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
4154 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
4155 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
4158 target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
4160 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4161 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4162 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4163 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4164 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4165 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4166 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4167 set_mem_align (target, align);
4169 emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
4172 else if (partial > 0)
4174 /* Scalar partly in registers. */
4176 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4177 int i;
4178 int not_stack;
4179 /* # bytes of start of argument
4180 that we must make space for but need not store. */
4181 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4182 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
4183 int skip;
4185 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4186 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4187 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4188 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4189 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4190 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4192 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
4193 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
4194 and leave the space uninitialized. */
4195 if (args_addr == 0)
4196 offset = 0;
4198 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
4199 allocate on the stack. Convert OFFSET to words too. */
4200 not_stack = (partial - offset) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4201 offset /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
4203 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4204 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4205 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4206 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4207 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
4209 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
4210 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
4212 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
4213 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
4214 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4215 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
4216 x = copy_to_reg (x);
4218 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
4219 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
4220 has a size a multiple of a word. */
4221 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
4222 for (i = not_stack; i < size; i++)
4223 #else
4224 for (i = size - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
4225 #endif
4226 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
4227 emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
4228 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
4229 0, args_addr,
4230 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
4231 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
4232 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad);
4234 else
4236 rtx addr;
4237 rtx dest;
4239 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4240 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4241 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4242 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4243 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4244 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4246 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4247 if (args_addr == 0 && PUSH_ARGS)
4248 emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
4249 else
4250 #endif
4252 if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
4253 addr
4254 = memory_address (mode,
4255 plus_constant (Pmode, args_addr,
4256 INTVAL (args_so_far)));
4257 else
4258 addr = memory_address (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, args_addr,
4259 args_so_far));
4260 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
4262 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4263 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4264 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4265 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4266 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4267 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4268 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4269 set_mem_align (dest, align);
4271 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
4275 /* If part should go in registers, copy that part
4276 into the appropriate registers. Do this now, at the end,
4277 since mem-to-mem copies above may do function calls. */
4278 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
4280 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4281 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4282 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
4283 emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
4284 else
4286 gcc_assert (partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
4287 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, partial / UNITS_PER_WORD, mode);
4291 if (extra && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
4292 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4294 if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
4295 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
4298 /* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
4299 operations. */
4301 static rtx
4302 get_subtarget (rtx x)
4304 return (optimize
4305 || x == 0
4306 /* Only registers can be subtargets. */
4307 || !REG_P (x)
4308 /* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
4309 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4310 ? 0 : x);
4313 /* A subroutine of expand_assignment. Optimize FIELD op= VAL, where
4314 FIELD is a bitfield. Returns true if the optimization was successful,
4315 and there's nothing else to do. */
4317 static bool
4318 optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
4319 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
4320 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start,
4321 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end,
4322 enum machine_mode mode1, rtx str_rtx,
4323 tree to, tree src)
4325 enum machine_mode str_mode = GET_MODE (str_rtx);
4326 unsigned int str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4327 tree op0, op1;
4328 rtx value, result;
4329 optab binop;
4330 gimple srcstmt;
4331 enum tree_code code;
4333 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
4334 || bitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
4335 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD
4336 || TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (to)
4337 || TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
4338 return false;
4340 STRIP_NOPS (src);
4341 if (TREE_CODE (src) != SSA_NAME)
4342 return false;
4343 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) != INTEGER_TYPE)
4344 return false;
4346 srcstmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (src);
4347 if (!srcstmt
4348 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt)) != tcc_binary)
4349 return false;
4351 code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
4353 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt);
4355 /* If OP0 is an SSA_NAME, then we want to walk the use-def chain
4356 to find its initialization. Hopefully the initialization will
4357 be from a bitfield load. */
4358 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
4360 gimple op0stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (op0);
4362 /* We want to eventually have OP0 be the same as TO, which
4363 should be a bitfield. */
4364 if (!op0stmt
4365 || !is_gimple_assign (op0stmt)
4366 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (op0stmt) != TREE_CODE (to))
4367 return false;
4368 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op0stmt);
4371 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt);
4373 if (!operand_equal_p (to, op0, 0))
4374 return false;
4376 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4378 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset1;
4380 if (str_bitsize == 0 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD)
4381 str_mode = word_mode;
4382 str_mode = get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos,
4383 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4384 MEM_ALIGN (str_rtx), str_mode, 0);
4385 if (str_mode == VOIDmode)
4386 return false;
4387 str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4389 offset1 = bitpos;
4390 bitpos %= str_bitsize;
4391 offset1 = (offset1 - bitpos) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
4392 str_rtx = adjust_address (str_rtx, str_mode, offset1);
4394 else if (!REG_P (str_rtx) && GET_CODE (str_rtx) != SUBREG)
4395 return false;
4397 /* If the bit field covers the whole REG/MEM, store_field
4398 will likely generate better code. */
4399 if (bitsize >= str_bitsize)
4400 return false;
4402 /* We can't handle fields split across multiple entities. */
4403 if (bitpos + bitsize > str_bitsize)
4404 return false;
4406 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4407 bitpos = str_bitsize - bitpos - bitsize;
4409 switch (code)
4411 case PLUS_EXPR:
4412 case MINUS_EXPR:
4413 /* For now, just optimize the case of the topmost bitfield
4414 where we don't need to do any masking and also
4415 1 bit bitfields where xor can be used.
4416 We might win by one instruction for the other bitfields
4417 too if insv/extv instructions aren't used, so that
4418 can be added later. */
4419 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize
4420 && (bitsize != 1 || TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST))
4421 break;
4423 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4424 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4425 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4426 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4428 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4429 we can alias adjacent data. */
4430 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4432 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4433 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4434 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4437 binop = code == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab : sub_optab;
4438 if (bitsize == 1 && bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4440 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, const1_rtx, NULL);
4441 binop = xor_optab;
4443 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4444 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4445 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4446 if (result != str_rtx)
4447 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4448 return true;
4450 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
4451 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
4452 if (TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST)
4453 break;
4454 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4455 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4456 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4457 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4459 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4460 we can alias adjacent data. */
4461 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4463 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4464 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4465 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4468 binop = code == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab : xor_optab;
4469 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4471 rtx mask = GEN_INT (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
4472 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, mask, NULL_RTX);
4474 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4475 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4476 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4477 if (result != str_rtx)
4478 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4479 return true;
4481 default:
4482 break;
4485 return false;
4488 /* In the C++ memory model, consecutive bit fields in a structure are
4489 considered one memory location.
4491 Given a COMPONENT_REF EXP at position (BITPOS, OFFSET), this function
4492 returns the bit range of consecutive bits in which this COMPONENT_REF
4493 belongs. The values are returned in *BITSTART and *BITEND. *BITPOS
4494 and *OFFSET may be adjusted in the process.
4496 If the access does not need to be restricted, 0 is returned in both
4497 *BITSTART and *BITEND. */
4499 static void
4500 get_bit_range (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *bitstart,
4501 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *bitend,
4502 tree exp,
4503 HOST_WIDE_INT *bitpos,
4504 tree *offset)
4506 HOST_WIDE_INT bitoffset;
4507 tree field, repr;
4509 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF);
4511 field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
4512 repr = DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE (field);
4513 /* If we do not have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE there is no
4514 need to limit the range we can access. */
4515 if (!repr)
4517 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
4518 return;
4521 /* If we have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE but the enclosing record is
4522 part of a larger bit field, then the representative does not serve any
4523 useful purpose. This can occur in Ada. */
4524 if (handled_component_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
4526 enum machine_mode rmode;
4527 HOST_WIDE_INT rbitsize, rbitpos;
4528 tree roffset;
4529 int unsignedp;
4530 int volatilep = 0;
4531 get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), &rbitsize, &rbitpos,
4532 &roffset, &rmode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
4533 if ((rbitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) != 0)
4535 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
4536 return;
4540 /* Compute the adjustment to bitpos from the offset of the field
4541 relative to the representative. DECL_FIELD_OFFSET of field and
4542 repr are the same by construction if they are not constants,
4543 see finish_bitfield_layout. */
4544 if (host_integerp (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), 1)
4545 && host_integerp (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (repr), 1))
4546 bitoffset = (tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), 1)
4547 - tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (repr), 1)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
4548 else
4549 bitoffset = 0;
4550 bitoffset += (tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field), 1)
4551 - tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (repr), 1));
4553 /* If the adjustment is larger than bitpos, we would have a negative bit
4554 position for the lower bound and this may wreak havoc later. This can
4555 occur only if we have a non-null offset, so adjust offset and bitpos
4556 to make the lower bound non-negative. */
4557 if (bitoffset > *bitpos)
4559 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust = bitoffset - *bitpos;
4561 gcc_assert ((adjust % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
4562 gcc_assert (*offset != NULL_TREE);
4564 *bitpos += adjust;
4565 *offset
4566 = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *offset, size_int (adjust / BITS_PER_UNIT));
4567 *bitstart = 0;
4569 else
4570 *bitstart = *bitpos - bitoffset;
4572 *bitend = *bitstart + tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (repr), 1) - 1;
4575 /* Returns true if ADDR is an ADDR_EXPR of a DECL that does not reside
4576 in memory and has non-BLKmode. DECL_RTL must not be a MEM; if
4577 DECL_RTL was not set yet, return NORTL. */
4579 static inline bool
4580 addr_expr_of_non_mem_decl_p_1 (tree addr, bool nortl)
4582 if (TREE_CODE (addr) != ADDR_EXPR)
4583 return false;
4585 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (addr, 0);
4587 if (!DECL_P (base)
4588 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (base)
4589 || DECL_MODE (base) == BLKmode)
4590 return false;
4592 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (base))
4593 return nortl;
4595 return (!MEM_P (DECL_RTL (base)));
4598 /* Returns true if the MEM_REF REF refers to an object that does not
4599 reside in memory and has non-BLKmode. */
4601 static inline bool
4602 mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (tree ref)
4604 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
4605 return addr_expr_of_non_mem_decl_p_1 (base, false);
4608 /* Return TRUE iff OP is an ADDR_EXPR of a DECL that's not
4609 addressable. This is very much like mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p,
4610 but instead of the MEM_REF, it takes its base, and it doesn't
4611 assume a DECL is in memory just because its RTL is not set yet. */
4613 bool
4614 addr_expr_of_non_mem_decl_p (tree op)
4616 return addr_expr_of_non_mem_decl_p_1 (op, true);
4619 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO. If NONTEMPORAL
4620 is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
4622 void
4623 expand_assignment (tree to, tree from, bool nontemporal)
4625 rtx to_rtx = 0;
4626 rtx result;
4627 enum machine_mode mode;
4628 unsigned int align;
4629 enum insn_code icode;
4631 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
4632 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
4634 expand_normal (from);
4635 return;
4638 /* Optimize away no-op moves without side-effects. */
4639 if (operand_equal_p (to, from, 0))
4640 return;
4642 /* Handle misaligned stores. */
4643 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to));
4644 if ((TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
4645 || TREE_CODE (to) == TARGET_MEM_REF)
4646 && mode != BLKmode
4647 && !mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to)
4648 && ((align = get_object_alignment (to))
4649 < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
4650 && (((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
4651 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4652 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, align)))
4654 rtx reg, mem;
4656 reg = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4657 reg = force_not_mem (reg);
4658 mem = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4660 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4662 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4664 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], mem);
4665 create_input_operand (&ops[1], reg, mode);
4666 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4667 would silently be omitted. */
4668 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4670 else
4671 store_bit_field (mem, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
4672 0, 0, 0, mode, reg);
4673 return;
4676 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
4677 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
4678 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
4679 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
4680 problem. Same for (partially) storing into a non-memory object. */
4681 if (handled_component_p (to)
4682 || (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
4683 && mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to))
4684 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4686 enum machine_mode mode1;
4687 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
4688 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start = 0;
4689 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end = 0;
4690 tree offset;
4691 int unsignedp;
4692 int volatilep = 0;
4693 tree tem;
4694 bool misalignp;
4695 rtx mem = NULL_RTX;
4697 push_temp_slots ();
4698 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
4699 &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
4701 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF
4702 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 1)))
4703 get_bit_range (&bitregion_start, &bitregion_end, to, &bitpos, &offset);
4705 /* If we are going to use store_bit_field and extract_bit_field,
4706 make sure to_rtx will be safe for multiple use. */
4707 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem));
4708 if (TREE_CODE (tem) == MEM_REF
4709 && mode != BLKmode
4710 && ((align = get_object_alignment (tem))
4711 < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
4712 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
4713 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
4715 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4717 misalignp = true;
4718 to_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
4719 mem = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4721 /* If the misaligned store doesn't overwrite all bits, perform
4722 rmw cycle on MEM. */
4723 if (bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
4725 create_input_operand (&ops[0], to_rtx, mode);
4726 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], mem);
4727 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4728 would silently be omitted. */
4729 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4731 mem = copy_rtx (mem);
4734 else
4736 misalignp = false;
4737 to_rtx = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4740 /* If the bitfield is volatile, we want to access it in the
4741 field's mode, not the computed mode.
4742 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
4743 use BLKmode for it instead. */
4744 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
4746 if (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
4747 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, 0);
4748 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == VOIDmode)
4749 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, BLKmode, 0);
4752 if (offset != 0)
4754 enum machine_mode address_mode;
4755 rtx offset_rtx;
4757 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx))
4759 /* We can get constant negative offsets into arrays with broken
4760 user code. Translate this to a trap instead of ICEing. */
4761 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST);
4762 expand_builtin_trap ();
4763 to_rtx = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx);
4766 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
4767 address_mode = get_address_mode (to_rtx);
4768 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
4769 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
4771 /* A constant address in TO_RTX can have VOIDmode, we must not try
4772 to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
4773 if (MEM_P (to_rtx)
4774 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode
4775 && GET_MODE (XEXP (to_rtx, 0)) != VOIDmode
4776 && bitsize > 0
4777 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
4778 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
4779 && MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
4781 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4782 bitpos = 0;
4785 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
4786 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (to,
4787 offset));
4790 /* No action is needed if the target is not a memory and the field
4791 lies completely outside that target. This can occur if the source
4792 code contains an out-of-bounds access to a small array. */
4793 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx)
4794 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) != BLKmode
4795 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bitpos
4796 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (to_rtx)))
4798 expand_normal (from);
4799 result = NULL;
4801 /* Handle expand_expr of a complex value returning a CONCAT. */
4802 else if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == CONCAT)
4804 unsigned short mode_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx));
4805 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)))
4806 && bitpos == 0
4807 && bitsize == mode_bitsize)
4808 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, false, nontemporal);
4809 else if (bitsize == mode_bitsize / 2
4810 && (bitpos == 0 || bitpos == mode_bitsize / 2))
4811 result = store_expr (from, XEXP (to_rtx, bitpos != 0), false,
4812 nontemporal);
4813 else if (bitpos + bitsize <= mode_bitsize / 2)
4814 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), bitsize, bitpos,
4815 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4816 mode1, from,
4817 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
4818 else if (bitpos >= mode_bitsize / 2)
4819 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), bitsize,
4820 bitpos - mode_bitsize / 2,
4821 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4822 mode1, from,
4823 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
4824 else if (bitpos == 0 && bitsize == mode_bitsize)
4826 rtx from_rtx;
4827 result = expand_normal (from);
4828 from_rtx = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), result,
4829 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)), 0);
4830 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0),
4831 read_complex_part (from_rtx, false));
4832 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1),
4833 read_complex_part (from_rtx, true));
4835 else
4837 rtx temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (to_rtx),
4838 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)));
4839 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), false);
4840 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 1), true);
4841 result = store_field (temp, bitsize, bitpos,
4842 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4843 mode1, from,
4844 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
4845 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), read_complex_part (temp, false));
4846 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), read_complex_part (temp, true));
4849 else
4851 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
4853 /* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
4854 DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
4855 to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4857 set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
4859 /* Deal with volatile and readonly fields. The former is only
4860 done for MEM. Also set MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P if needed. */
4861 if (volatilep)
4862 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4865 if (optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (bitsize, bitpos,
4866 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4867 mode1,
4868 to_rtx, to, from))
4869 result = NULL;
4870 else
4871 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos,
4872 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4873 mode1, from,
4874 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
4877 if (misalignp)
4879 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4881 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], mem);
4882 create_input_operand (&ops[1], to_rtx, mode);
4883 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4884 would silently be omitted. */
4885 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4888 if (result)
4889 preserve_temp_slots (result);
4890 pop_temp_slots ();
4891 return;
4894 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
4895 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
4896 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
4897 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
4898 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
4900 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
4901 since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
4902 needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
4903 computation is done before the call. The same is true for SSA names. */
4904 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from, from)
4905 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (from))
4906 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
4907 && ! (((TREE_CODE (to) == VAR_DECL
4908 || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL
4909 || TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL)
4910 && REG_P (DECL_RTL (to)))
4911 || TREE_CODE (to) == SSA_NAME))
4913 rtx value;
4915 push_temp_slots ();
4916 value = expand_normal (from);
4917 if (to_rtx == 0)
4918 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4920 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4921 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4922 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4924 if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
4925 emit_group_move (to_rtx, value);
4926 else
4927 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
4928 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4930 else if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
4931 emit_group_store (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
4932 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4933 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
4935 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
4936 if (REG_P (value))
4937 copy_blkmode_from_reg (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from));
4938 else
4939 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
4941 else
4943 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to)))
4944 value = convert_memory_address_addr_space
4945 (GET_MODE (to_rtx), value,
4946 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (to))));
4948 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
4950 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4951 pop_temp_slots ();
4952 return;
4955 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx. */
4956 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4958 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
4959 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
4960 && (REG_P (to_rtx) || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
4962 rtx temp;
4964 push_temp_slots ();
4966 /* If the source is itself a return value, it still is in a pseudo at
4967 this point so we can move it back to the return register directly. */
4968 if (REG_P (to_rtx)
4969 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == BLKmode
4970 && TREE_CODE (from) != CALL_EXPR)
4971 temp = copy_blkmode_to_reg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), from);
4972 else
4973 temp = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (to_rtx), EXPAND_NORMAL);
4975 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4976 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4977 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4979 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
4980 emit_group_move (to_rtx, temp);
4981 else
4982 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
4983 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4985 else if (temp)
4986 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
4988 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4989 pop_temp_slots ();
4990 return;
4993 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
4994 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
4995 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
4996 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
4997 && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
4998 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P
4999 (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (from, 0)))))
5000 && refs_may_alias_p (to, from)
5001 && cfun->returns_struct
5002 && !cfun->returns_pcc_struct)
5004 rtx from_rtx, size;
5006 push_temp_slots ();
5007 size = expr_size (from);
5008 from_rtx = expand_normal (from);
5010 emit_library_call (memmove_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
5011 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
5012 XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
5013 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
5014 size, TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
5015 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
5017 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
5018 pop_temp_slots ();
5019 return;
5022 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
5024 push_temp_slots ();
5025 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal);
5026 preserve_temp_slots (result);
5027 pop_temp_slots ();
5028 return;
5031 /* Emits nontemporal store insn that moves FROM to TO. Returns true if this
5032 succeeded, false otherwise. */
5034 bool
5035 emit_storent_insn (rtx to, rtx from)
5037 struct expand_operand ops[2];
5038 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (to);
5039 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (storent_optab, mode);
5041 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
5042 return false;
5044 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], to);
5045 create_input_operand (&ops[1], from, mode);
5046 return maybe_expand_insn (code, 2, ops);
5049 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
5050 and storing the value into TARGET.
5052 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
5053 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
5054 because C has no operators that could combine two different
5055 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
5056 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
5057 be more thorough?
5059 If CALL_PARAM_P is nonzero, this is a store into a call param on the
5060 stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially.
5062 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try using a nontemporal store instruction. */
5065 store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int call_param_p, bool nontemporal)
5067 rtx temp;
5068 rtx alt_rtl = NULL_RTX;
5069 location_t loc = curr_insn_location ();
5071 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5073 /* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
5074 branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
5075 store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
5076 gcc_assert (!call_param_p);
5077 expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5078 return NULL_RTX;
5080 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
5082 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
5083 part. */
5084 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
5085 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5086 return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
5087 nontemporal);
5089 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5091 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
5092 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
5093 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
5094 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
5096 rtx lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
5098 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
5099 NO_DEFER_POP;
5100 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1, -1);
5101 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
5102 nontemporal);
5103 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (lab2));
5104 emit_barrier ();
5105 emit_label (lab1);
5106 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, call_param_p,
5107 nontemporal);
5108 emit_label (lab2);
5109 OK_DEFER_POP;
5111 return NULL_RTX;
5113 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
5114 /* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
5115 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
5116 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
5117 expression. */
5119 rtx inner_target = 0;
5121 /* We can do the conversion inside EXP, which will often result
5122 in some optimizations. Do the conversion in two steps: first
5123 change the signedness, if needed, then the extend. But don't
5124 do this if the type of EXP is a subtype of something else
5125 since then the conversion might involve more than just
5126 converting modes. */
5127 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5128 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0
5129 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (target))
5130 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5132 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5133 != SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target))
5135 /* Some types, e.g. Fortran's logical*4, won't have a signed
5136 version, so use the mode instead. */
5137 tree ntype
5138 = (signed_or_unsigned_type_for
5139 (SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5140 if (ntype == NULL)
5141 ntype = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5142 (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5143 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5145 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, ntype, exp);
5148 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5149 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
5150 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target)),
5151 exp);
5153 inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
5156 temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
5157 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5159 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
5160 sure that we properly convert it. */
5161 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
5163 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5164 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5165 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
5166 GET_MODE (target), temp,
5167 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5170 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
5171 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5173 return NULL_RTX;
5175 else if ((TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5176 || (TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
5177 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
5178 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
5179 == STRING_CST
5180 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
5181 && !nontemporal && !call_param_p
5182 && MEM_P (target))
5184 /* Optimize initialization of an array with a STRING_CST. */
5185 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_len, str_copy_len;
5186 rtx dest_mem;
5187 tree str = TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5188 ? exp : TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
5190 exp_len = int_expr_size (exp);
5191 if (exp_len <= 0)
5192 goto normal_expr;
5194 if (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) <= 0)
5195 goto normal_expr;
5197 str_copy_len = strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (str));
5198 if (str_copy_len < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - 1)
5199 goto normal_expr;
5201 str_copy_len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str);
5202 if ((STORE_MAX_PIECES & (STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1)) == 0
5203 && TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)[TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - 1] == '\0')
5205 str_copy_len += STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1;
5206 str_copy_len &= ~(STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1);
5208 str_copy_len = MIN (str_copy_len, exp_len);
5209 if (!can_store_by_pieces (str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
5210 CONST_CAST (char *, TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
5211 MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
5212 goto normal_expr;
5214 dest_mem = target;
5216 dest_mem = store_by_pieces (dest_mem,
5217 str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
5218 CONST_CAST (char *,
5219 TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
5220 MEM_ALIGN (target), false,
5221 exp_len > str_copy_len ? 1 : 0);
5222 if (exp_len > str_copy_len)
5223 clear_storage (adjust_address (dest_mem, BLKmode, 0),
5224 GEN_INT (exp_len - str_copy_len),
5225 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5226 return NULL_RTX;
5228 else
5230 rtx tmp_target;
5232 normal_expr:
5233 /* If we want to use a nontemporal store, force the value to
5234 register first. */
5235 tmp_target = nontemporal ? NULL_RTX : target;
5236 temp = expand_expr_real (exp, tmp_target, GET_MODE (target),
5237 (call_param_p
5238 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL),
5239 &alt_rtl);
5242 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
5243 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
5244 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE and we want only a word-sized
5245 value. */
5246 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
5247 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5248 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5249 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5250 temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5252 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
5253 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary and emit the
5254 pending incrementations that have been queued when expanding EXP.
5255 Note that we cannot emit the whole queue blindly because this will
5256 effectively disable the POST_INC optimization later.
5258 If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
5259 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
5260 two cases:
5261 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
5262 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
5263 to == .
5264 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
5265 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
5266 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
5267 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
5268 of volatile memory references. */
5270 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
5271 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
5272 || side_effects_p (target))))
5273 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5274 /* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
5275 but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
5276 from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
5277 && !(alt_rtl
5278 && rtx_equal_p (alt_rtl, target)
5279 && !side_effects_p (alt_rtl)
5280 && !side_effects_p (target))
5281 /* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call
5282 expr_size unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++)
5283 expr_size-hook must not be given objects that are not
5284 supposed to be bit-copied or bit-initialized. */
5285 && expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
5287 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target) && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
5289 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5291 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
5292 if (REG_P (temp) && TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
5293 copy_blkmode_from_reg (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp));
5294 else
5295 store_bit_field (target,
5296 INTVAL (expr_size (exp)) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
5297 0, 0, 0, GET_MODE (temp), temp);
5299 else
5300 convert_move (target, temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5303 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
5305 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
5306 constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
5307 actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
5308 type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
5309 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
5311 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
5312 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
5313 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
5314 (call_param_p
5315 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5316 else
5318 enum machine_mode pointer_mode
5319 = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (target));
5320 enum machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (target);
5322 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
5323 tree copy_size
5324 = size_binop_loc (loc, MIN_EXPR,
5325 make_tree (sizetype, size),
5326 size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
5327 rtx copy_size_rtx
5328 = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
5329 (call_param_p
5330 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
5331 rtx label = 0;
5333 /* Copy that much. */
5334 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (pointer_mode, copy_size_rtx,
5335 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5336 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
5337 (call_param_p
5338 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5340 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
5341 Do all calculations in pointer_mode. */
5342 if (CONST_INT_P (copy_size_rtx))
5344 size = plus_constant (address_mode, size,
5345 -INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
5346 target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode,
5347 INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
5349 else
5351 size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
5352 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
5353 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5355 if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != address_mode)
5356 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode,
5357 copy_size_rtx,
5358 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5360 target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
5361 highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
5362 label = gen_label_rtx ();
5363 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
5364 GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
5367 if (size != const0_rtx)
5368 clear_storage (target, size, BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5370 if (label)
5371 emit_label (label);
5374 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5375 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5376 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
5378 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5379 emit_group_move (target, temp);
5380 else
5381 emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
5382 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5384 else if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
5385 emit_group_store (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
5386 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5387 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
5388 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
5389 (call_param_p
5390 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5391 /* If we emit a nontemporal store, there is nothing else to do. */
5392 else if (nontemporal && emit_storent_insn (target, temp))
5394 else
5396 temp = force_operand (temp, target);
5397 if (temp != target)
5398 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
5402 return NULL_RTX;
5405 /* Return true if field F of structure TYPE is a flexible array. */
5407 static bool
5408 flexible_array_member_p (const_tree f, const_tree type)
5410 const_tree tf;
5412 tf = TREE_TYPE (f);
5413 return (DECL_CHAIN (f) == NULL
5414 && TREE_CODE (tf) == ARRAY_TYPE
5415 && TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)
5416 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5417 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)))
5418 && !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5419 && int_size_in_bytes (type) >= 0);
5422 /* If FOR_CTOR_P, return the number of top-level elements that a constructor
5423 must have in order for it to completely initialize a value of type TYPE.
5424 Return -1 if the number isn't known.
5426 If !FOR_CTOR_P, return an estimate of the number of scalars in TYPE. */
5428 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5429 count_type_elements (const_tree type, bool for_ctor_p)
5431 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5433 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5435 tree nelts;
5437 nelts = array_type_nelts (type);
5438 if (nelts && host_integerp (nelts, 1))
5440 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5442 n = tree_low_cst (nelts, 1) + 1;
5443 if (n == 0 || for_ctor_p)
5444 return n;
5445 else
5446 return n * count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (type), false);
5448 return for_ctor_p ? -1 : 1;
5451 case RECORD_TYPE:
5453 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5454 tree f;
5456 n = 0;
5457 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5458 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5460 if (!for_ctor_p)
5461 n += count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5462 else if (!flexible_array_member_p (f, type))
5463 /* Don't count flexible arrays, which are not supposed
5464 to be initialized. */
5465 n += 1;
5468 return n;
5471 case UNION_TYPE:
5472 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5474 tree f;
5475 HOST_WIDE_INT n, m;
5477 gcc_assert (!for_ctor_p);
5478 /* Estimate the number of scalars in each field and pick the
5479 maximum. Other estimates would do instead; the idea is simply
5480 to make sure that the estimate is not sensitive to the ordering
5481 of the fields. */
5482 n = 1;
5483 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5484 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5486 m = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5487 /* If the field doesn't span the whole union, add an extra
5488 scalar for the rest. */
5489 if (simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (f)),
5490 TYPE_SIZE (type)) != 1)
5491 m++;
5492 if (n < m)
5493 n = m;
5495 return n;
5498 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
5499 return 2;
5501 case VECTOR_TYPE:
5502 return TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
5504 case INTEGER_TYPE:
5505 case REAL_TYPE:
5506 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
5507 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
5508 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
5509 case POINTER_TYPE:
5510 case OFFSET_TYPE:
5511 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
5512 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
5513 return 1;
5515 case ERROR_MARK:
5516 return 0;
5518 case VOID_TYPE:
5519 case METHOD_TYPE:
5520 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
5521 case LANG_TYPE:
5522 default:
5523 gcc_unreachable ();
5527 /* Helper for categorize_ctor_elements. Identical interface. */
5529 static bool
5530 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
5531 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
5533 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5534 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts, num_fields;
5535 tree value, purpose, elt_type;
5537 /* Whether CTOR is a valid constant initializer, in accordance with what
5538 initializer_constant_valid_p does. If inferred from the constructor
5539 elements, true until proven otherwise. */
5540 bool const_from_elts_p = constructor_static_from_elts_p (ctor);
5541 bool const_p = const_from_elts_p ? true : TREE_STATIC (ctor);
5543 nz_elts = 0;
5544 init_elts = 0;
5545 num_fields = 0;
5546 elt_type = NULL_TREE;
5548 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor), idx, purpose, value)
5550 HOST_WIDE_INT mult = 1;
5552 if (purpose && TREE_CODE (purpose) == RANGE_EXPR)
5554 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 0);
5555 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 1);
5557 if (host_integerp (lo_index, 1) && host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
5558 mult = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
5559 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
5561 num_fields += mult;
5562 elt_type = TREE_TYPE (value);
5564 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
5566 case CONSTRUCTOR:
5568 HOST_WIDE_INT nz = 0, ic = 0;
5570 bool const_elt_p = categorize_ctor_elements_1 (value, &nz, &ic,
5571 p_complete);
5573 nz_elts += mult * nz;
5574 init_elts += mult * ic;
5576 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
5577 const_p = const_elt_p;
5579 break;
5581 case INTEGER_CST:
5582 case REAL_CST:
5583 case FIXED_CST:
5584 if (!initializer_zerop (value))
5585 nz_elts += mult;
5586 init_elts += mult;
5587 break;
5589 case STRING_CST:
5590 nz_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
5591 init_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
5592 break;
5594 case COMPLEX_CST:
5595 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_REALPART (value)))
5596 nz_elts += mult;
5597 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_IMAGPART (value)))
5598 nz_elts += mult;
5599 init_elts += mult;
5600 break;
5602 case VECTOR_CST:
5604 unsigned i;
5605 for (i = 0; i < VECTOR_CST_NELTS (value); ++i)
5607 tree v = VECTOR_CST_ELT (value, i);
5608 if (!initializer_zerop (v))
5609 nz_elts += mult;
5610 init_elts += mult;
5613 break;
5615 default:
5617 HOST_WIDE_INT tc = count_type_elements (elt_type, false);
5618 nz_elts += mult * tc;
5619 init_elts += mult * tc;
5621 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
5622 const_p = initializer_constant_valid_p (value, elt_type)
5623 != NULL_TREE;
5625 break;
5629 if (*p_complete && !complete_ctor_at_level_p (TREE_TYPE (ctor),
5630 num_fields, elt_type))
5631 *p_complete = false;
5633 *p_nz_elts += nz_elts;
5634 *p_init_elts += init_elts;
5636 return const_p;
5639 /* Examine CTOR to discover:
5640 * how many scalar fields are set to nonzero values,
5641 and place it in *P_NZ_ELTS;
5642 * how many scalar fields in total are in CTOR,
5643 and place it in *P_ELT_COUNT.
5644 * whether the constructor is complete -- in the sense that every
5645 meaningful byte is explicitly given a value --
5646 and place it in *P_COMPLETE.
5648 Return whether or not CTOR is a valid static constant initializer, the same
5649 as "initializer_constant_valid_p (CTOR, TREE_TYPE (CTOR)) != 0". */
5651 bool
5652 categorize_ctor_elements (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
5653 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
5655 *p_nz_elts = 0;
5656 *p_init_elts = 0;
5657 *p_complete = true;
5659 return categorize_ctor_elements_1 (ctor, p_nz_elts, p_init_elts, p_complete);
5662 /* TYPE is initialized by a constructor with NUM_ELTS elements, the last
5663 of which had type LAST_TYPE. Each element was itself a complete
5664 initializer, in the sense that every meaningful byte was explicitly
5665 given a value. Return true if the same is true for the constructor
5666 as a whole. */
5668 bool
5669 complete_ctor_at_level_p (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT num_elts,
5670 const_tree last_type)
5672 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
5673 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
5675 if (num_elts == 0)
5676 return false;
5678 gcc_assert (num_elts == 1 && last_type);
5680 /* ??? We could look at each element of the union, and find the
5681 largest element. Which would avoid comparing the size of the
5682 initialized element against any tail padding in the union.
5683 Doesn't seem worth the effort... */
5684 return simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (type), TYPE_SIZE (last_type)) == 1;
5687 return count_type_elements (type, true) == num_elts;
5690 /* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
5692 static int
5693 mostly_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5695 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5697 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts;
5698 bool complete_p;
5700 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &init_elts, &complete_p);
5701 return !complete_p || nz_elts < init_elts / 4;
5704 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5707 /* Return 1 if EXP contains all zeros. */
5709 static int
5710 all_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5712 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5714 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts;
5715 bool complete_p;
5717 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &init_elts, &complete_p);
5718 return nz_elts == 0;
5721 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5724 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
5725 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
5726 CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
5727 ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
5729 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
5730 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
5731 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
5732 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
5734 static void
5735 store_constructor_field (rtx target, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
5736 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, enum machine_mode mode,
5737 tree exp, int cleared, alias_set_type alias_set)
5739 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
5740 /* We can only call store_constructor recursively if the size and
5741 bit position are on a byte boundary. */
5742 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
5743 && (bitsize > 0 && bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
5744 /* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
5745 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
5746 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
5747 && (bitpos == 0 || MEM_P (target)))
5749 if (MEM_P (target))
5750 target
5751 = adjust_address (target,
5752 GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
5753 || 0 != (bitpos
5754 % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (target)))
5755 ? BLKmode : VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5758 /* Update the alias set, if required. */
5759 if (MEM_P (target) && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
5760 && MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
5762 target = copy_rtx (target);
5763 set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
5766 store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5768 else
5769 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0, 0, mode, exp, alias_set, false);
5772 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
5773 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
5774 safe_from_p has been called.
5775 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
5776 SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
5777 may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
5778 which has been packed to exclude padding bits. */
5780 static void
5781 store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
5783 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
5784 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5785 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
5786 #endif
5788 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5790 case RECORD_TYPE:
5791 case UNION_TYPE:
5792 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5794 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5795 tree field, value;
5797 /* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
5798 if (size == 0 || cleared)
5799 cleared = 1;
5800 /* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
5801 else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
5802 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
5803 && ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
5804 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
5806 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5807 cleared = 1;
5810 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
5811 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
5812 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
5813 this probably loses. */
5814 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp)
5815 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
5817 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
5818 cleared = 1;
5821 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure or
5822 if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros, clear
5823 the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
5824 register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since
5825 clear_storage can't handle this case. */
5826 else if (size > 0
5827 && (((int)vec_safe_length (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
5828 != fields_length (type))
5829 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
5830 && (!REG_P (target)
5831 || ((HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))
5832 == size)))
5834 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5835 cleared = 1;
5838 if (REG_P (target) && !cleared)
5839 emit_clobber (target);
5841 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
5842 corresponding field of TARGET. */
5843 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, field, value)
5845 enum machine_mode mode;
5846 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
5847 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
5848 tree offset;
5849 rtx to_rtx = target;
5851 /* Just ignore missing fields. We cleared the whole
5852 structure, above, if any fields are missing. */
5853 if (field == 0)
5854 continue;
5856 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
5857 continue;
5859 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (field), 1))
5860 bitsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (field), 1);
5861 else
5862 bitsize = -1;
5864 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
5865 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
5866 mode = VOIDmode;
5868 offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
5869 if (host_integerp (offset, 0)
5870 && host_integerp (bit_position (field), 0))
5872 bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
5873 offset = 0;
5875 else
5876 bitpos = tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field), 0);
5878 if (offset)
5880 enum machine_mode address_mode;
5881 rtx offset_rtx;
5883 offset
5884 = SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (offset,
5885 make_tree (TREE_TYPE (exp),
5886 target));
5888 offset_rtx = expand_normal (offset);
5889 gcc_assert (MEM_P (to_rtx));
5891 address_mode = get_address_mode (to_rtx);
5892 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
5893 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
5895 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
5896 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
5899 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5900 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a
5901 word, at the start of a word, try to widen it to a full
5902 word. This special case allows us to output C++ member
5903 function initializations in a form that the optimizers
5904 can understand. */
5905 if (REG_P (target)
5906 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
5907 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
5908 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5909 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
5910 && exp_size >= 0
5911 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
5913 tree type = TREE_TYPE (value);
5915 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
5917 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5918 (word_mode, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
5919 value = fold_convert (type, value);
5922 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
5923 value
5924 = fold_build2 (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
5925 build_int_cst (type,
5926 BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize));
5927 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
5928 mode = word_mode;
5930 #endif
5932 if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
5933 && DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
5935 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5936 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
5939 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
5940 value, cleared,
5941 get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)));
5943 break;
5945 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5947 tree value, index;
5948 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i;
5949 int need_to_clear;
5950 tree domain;
5951 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
5952 int const_bounds_p;
5953 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
5954 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
5956 domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
5957 const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
5958 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
5959 && host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0)
5960 && host_integerp (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0));
5962 /* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
5963 if (const_bounds_p)
5965 minelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0);
5966 maxelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0);
5969 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array, clear
5970 the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
5971 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
5972 if (cleared)
5973 need_to_clear = 0;
5974 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
5975 need_to_clear = 1;
5976 else
5978 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5979 tree index, value;
5980 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
5981 need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
5983 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
5984 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index). It
5985 is also needed to check for missing elements. */
5986 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, index, value)
5988 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
5990 if (need_to_clear)
5991 break;
5993 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
5995 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
5996 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
5998 if (! host_integerp (lo_index, 1)
5999 || ! host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
6001 need_to_clear = 1;
6002 break;
6005 this_node_count = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
6006 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
6008 else
6009 this_node_count = 1;
6011 count += this_node_count;
6012 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
6013 zero_count += this_node_count;
6016 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing
6017 elements, or if the incidence of zero elements is >=
6018 75%. */
6019 if (! need_to_clear
6020 && (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
6021 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
6022 need_to_clear = 1;
6025 if (need_to_clear && size > 0)
6027 if (REG_P (target))
6028 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6029 else
6030 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6031 cleared = 1;
6034 if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
6035 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
6036 emit_clobber (target);
6038 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
6039 corresponding element of TARGET, determined by counting the
6040 elements. */
6041 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i, index, value)
6043 enum machine_mode mode;
6044 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6045 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
6046 rtx xtarget = target;
6048 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6049 continue;
6051 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
6052 if (mode == BLKmode)
6053 bitsize = (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
6054 ? tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
6055 : -1);
6056 else
6057 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6059 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
6061 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
6062 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
6063 rtx index_r, pos_rtx;
6064 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
6065 tree position;
6067 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
6068 if (const_bounds_p
6069 && host_integerp (lo_index, 0)
6070 && host_integerp (hi_index, 0)
6071 && (lo = tree_low_cst (lo_index, 0),
6072 hi = tree_low_cst (hi_index, 0),
6073 count = hi - lo + 1,
6074 (!MEM_P (target)
6075 || count <= 2
6076 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
6077 && (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1) * count
6078 <= 40 * 8)))))
6080 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
6081 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
6083 bitpos = lo * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0);
6085 if (MEM_P (target)
6086 && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6087 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6088 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6090 target = copy_rtx (target);
6091 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6094 store_constructor_field
6095 (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value, cleared,
6096 get_alias_set (elttype));
6099 else
6101 rtx loop_start = gen_label_rtx ();
6102 rtx loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
6103 tree exit_cond;
6105 expand_normal (hi_index);
6107 index = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
6108 VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
6109 index_r = gen_reg_rtx (promote_decl_mode (index, NULL));
6110 SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
6111 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0, false);
6113 /* Build the head of the loop. */
6114 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
6115 emit_label (loop_start);
6117 /* Assign value to element index. */
6118 position =
6119 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6120 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6121 TREE_TYPE (index),
6122 index,
6123 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6125 position =
6126 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
6127 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6128 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6130 pos_rtx = expand_normal (position);
6131 xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
6132 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6133 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6134 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6135 store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
6136 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6137 else
6138 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
6140 /* Generate a conditional jump to exit the loop. */
6141 exit_cond = build2 (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
6142 index, hi_index);
6143 jumpif (exit_cond, loop_end, -1);
6145 /* Update the loop counter, and jump to the head of
6146 the loop. */
6147 expand_assignment (index,
6148 build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6149 index, integer_one_node),
6150 false);
6152 emit_jump (loop_start);
6154 /* Build the end of the loop. */
6155 emit_label (loop_end);
6158 else if ((index != 0 && ! host_integerp (index, 0))
6159 || ! host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1))
6161 tree position;
6163 if (index == 0)
6164 index = ssize_int (1);
6166 if (minelt)
6167 index = fold_convert (ssizetype,
6168 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6169 TREE_TYPE (index),
6170 index,
6171 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6173 position =
6174 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
6175 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6176 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6177 xtarget = offset_address (target,
6178 expand_normal (position),
6179 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6180 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6181 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
6183 else
6185 if (index != 0)
6186 bitpos = ((tree_low_cst (index, 0) - minelt)
6187 * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
6188 else
6189 bitpos = (i * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
6191 if (MEM_P (target) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6192 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6193 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6195 target = copy_rtx (target);
6196 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6198 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value,
6199 cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
6202 break;
6205 case VECTOR_TYPE:
6207 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6208 constructor_elt *ce;
6209 int i;
6210 int need_to_clear;
6211 int icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
6212 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
6213 int elt_size = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1);
6214 enum machine_mode eltmode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
6215 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6216 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
6217 rtvec vector = NULL;
6218 unsigned n_elts;
6219 alias_set_type alias;
6221 gcc_assert (eltmode != BLKmode);
6223 n_elts = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
6224 if (REG_P (target) && VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (target)))
6226 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
6228 icode = (int) optab_handler (vec_init_optab, mode);
6229 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6231 unsigned int i;
6233 vector = rtvec_alloc (n_elts);
6234 for (i = 0; i < n_elts; i++)
6235 RTVEC_ELT (vector, i) = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
6239 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the vector,
6240 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
6241 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
6242 if (cleared)
6243 need_to_clear = 0;
6244 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
6245 need_to_clear = 1;
6246 else
6248 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
6249 tree value;
6251 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
6253 int n_elts_here = tree_low_cst
6254 (int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
6255 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)),
6256 TYPE_SIZE (elttype)), 1);
6258 count += n_elts_here;
6259 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
6260 zero_count += n_elts_here;
6263 /* Clear the entire vector first if there are any missing elements,
6264 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
6265 need_to_clear = (count < n_elts || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count);
6268 if (need_to_clear && size > 0 && !vector)
6270 if (REG_P (target))
6271 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6272 else
6273 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6274 cleared = 1;
6277 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
6278 if (!cleared && !vector && REG_P (target))
6279 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6281 if (MEM_P (target))
6282 alias = MEM_ALIAS_SET (target);
6283 else
6284 alias = get_alias_set (elttype);
6286 /* Store each element of the constructor into the corresponding
6287 element of TARGET, determined by counting the elements. */
6288 for (idx = 0, i = 0;
6289 vec_safe_iterate (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, &ce);
6290 idx++, i += bitsize / elt_size)
6292 HOST_WIDE_INT eltpos;
6293 tree value = ce->value;
6295 bitsize = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)), 1);
6296 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6297 continue;
6299 if (ce->index)
6300 eltpos = tree_low_cst (ce->index, 1);
6301 else
6302 eltpos = i;
6304 if (vector)
6306 /* Vector CONSTRUCTORs should only be built from smaller
6307 vectors in the case of BLKmode vectors. */
6308 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) != VECTOR_TYPE);
6309 RTVEC_ELT (vector, eltpos)
6310 = expand_normal (value);
6312 else
6314 enum machine_mode value_mode =
6315 TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE
6316 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (value))
6317 : eltmode;
6318 bitpos = eltpos * elt_size;
6319 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, value_mode,
6320 value, cleared, alias);
6324 if (vector)
6325 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode)
6326 (target,
6327 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (target), vector)));
6328 break;
6331 default:
6332 gcc_unreachable ();
6336 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
6337 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
6338 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
6339 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
6341 BITREGION_START is bitpos of the first bitfield in this region.
6342 BITREGION_END is the bitpos of the ending bitfield in this region.
6343 These two fields are 0, if the C++ memory model does not apply,
6344 or we are not interested in keeping track of bitfield regions.
6346 Always return const0_rtx unless we have something particular to
6347 return.
6349 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
6350 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
6351 reference to the containing structure.
6353 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
6355 static rtx
6356 store_field (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
6357 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start,
6358 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end,
6359 enum machine_mode mode, tree exp,
6360 alias_set_type alias_set, bool nontemporal)
6362 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
6363 return const0_rtx;
6365 /* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
6366 side-effects. */
6367 if (bitsize == 0)
6368 return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6370 if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
6372 /* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
6374 gcc_assert (!bitpos);
6375 return store_expr (exp, target, 0, nontemporal);
6378 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
6379 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
6380 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
6382 if (mode == VOIDmode
6383 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
6384 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
6385 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
6386 || REG_P (target)
6387 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
6388 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
6389 store it as a bit field. */
6390 || (mode != BLKmode
6391 && ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
6392 || bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
6393 && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
6394 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
6395 || (bitsize >= 0 && mode != BLKmode
6396 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > bitsize)
6397 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
6398 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
6399 operations. */
6400 || (bitsize >= 0
6401 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
6402 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) != 0)
6403 /* If we are expanding a MEM_REF of a non-BLKmode non-addressable
6404 decl we must use bitfield operations. */
6405 || (bitsize >= 0
6406 && TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
6407 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
6408 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
6409 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),0 ))
6410 && DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)) != BLKmode))
6412 rtx temp;
6413 gimple nop_def;
6415 /* If EXP is a NOP_EXPR of precision less than its mode, then that
6416 implies a mask operation. If the precision is the same size as
6417 the field we're storing into, that mask is redundant. This is
6418 particularly common with bit field assignments generated by the
6419 C front end. */
6420 nop_def = get_def_for_expr (exp, NOP_EXPR);
6421 if (nop_def)
6423 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
6424 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
6425 && TYPE_PRECISION (type) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))
6426 && bitsize == TYPE_PRECISION (type))
6428 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (nop_def);
6429 type = TREE_TYPE (op);
6430 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && TYPE_PRECISION (type) >= bitsize)
6431 exp = op;
6435 temp = expand_normal (exp);
6437 /* If BITSIZE is narrower than the size of the type of EXP
6438 we will be narrowing TEMP. Normally, what's wanted are the
6439 low-order bits. However, if EXP's type is a record and this is
6440 big-endian machine, we want the upper BITSIZE bits. */
6441 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
6442 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
6443 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == RECORD_TYPE)
6444 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (temp), temp,
6445 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp)) - bitsize,
6446 NULL_RTX, 1);
6448 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to MODE. */
6449 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
6450 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6451 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
6453 /* If the modes of TEMP and TARGET are both BLKmode, both
6454 must be in memory and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte
6455 boundary. If so, we simply do a block copy. Likewise
6456 for a BLKmode-like TARGET. */
6457 if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode
6458 && (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
6459 || (MEM_P (target)
6460 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (target)) == MODE_INT
6461 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
6462 && (bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)))
6464 gcc_assert (MEM_P (target) && MEM_P (temp)
6465 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
6467 target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6468 emit_block_move (target, temp,
6469 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
6470 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
6471 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6473 return const0_rtx;
6476 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
6477 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
6478 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
6480 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6481 rtx temp_target;
6482 if (mode == BLKmode)
6483 mode = smallest_mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT);
6484 temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
6485 emit_group_store (temp_target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp), size);
6486 temp = temp_target;
6488 else if (mode == BLKmode)
6490 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
6491 if (REG_P (temp) && TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
6493 rtx temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (temp));
6494 copy_blkmode_from_reg (temp_target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp));
6495 temp = temp_target;
6497 else
6499 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6500 rtx temp_target;
6501 mode = smallest_mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT);
6502 temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
6503 temp_target
6504 = extract_bit_field (temp, size * BITS_PER_UNIT, 0, 1,
6505 false, temp_target, mode, mode);
6506 temp = temp_target;
6510 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
6511 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
6512 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6513 mode, temp);
6515 return const0_rtx;
6517 else
6519 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
6520 rtx to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6522 if (to_rtx == target)
6523 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
6525 if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
6526 set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
6528 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal);
6532 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
6533 an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
6534 codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
6536 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
6537 bit position, and *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness of the field.
6538 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
6539 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
6540 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
6541 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
6543 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
6544 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
6546 If the field is a non-BLKmode bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode.
6547 Otherwise, it is a mode that can be used to access the field.
6549 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
6550 BLKmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
6551 this case, but the address of the object can be found.
6553 If KEEP_ALIGNING is true and the target is STRICT_ALIGNMENT, we don't
6554 look through nodes that serve as markers of a greater alignment than
6555 the one that can be deduced from the expression. These nodes make it
6556 possible for front-ends to prevent temporaries from being created by
6557 the middle-end on alignment considerations. For that purpose, the
6558 normal operating mode at high-level is to always pass FALSE so that
6559 the ultimate containing object is really returned; moreover, the
6560 associated predicate handled_component_p will always return TRUE
6561 on these nodes, thus indicating that they are essentially handled
6562 by get_inner_reference. TRUE should only be passed when the caller
6563 is scanning the expression in order to build another representation
6564 and specifically knows how to handle these nodes; as such, this is
6565 the normal operating mode in the RTL expanders. */
6567 tree
6568 get_inner_reference (tree exp, HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitsize,
6569 HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
6570 enum machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
6571 int *pvolatilep, bool keep_aligning)
6573 tree size_tree = 0;
6574 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
6575 bool blkmode_bitfield = false;
6576 tree offset = size_zero_node;
6577 double_int bit_offset = double_int_zero;
6579 /* First get the mode, signedness, and size. We do this from just the
6580 outermost expression. */
6581 *pbitsize = -1;
6582 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
6584 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6585 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (field);
6586 if (!DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
6587 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
6588 else if (DECL_MODE (field) == BLKmode)
6589 blkmode_bitfield = true;
6590 else if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
6591 && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
6592 /* Volatile bitfields should be accessed in the mode of the
6593 field's type, not the mode computed based on the bit
6594 size. */
6595 mode = TYPE_MODE (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field));
6597 *punsignedp = DECL_UNSIGNED (field);
6599 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
6601 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6602 *punsignedp = (! INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6603 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6605 /* For vector types, with the correct size of access, use the mode of
6606 inner type. */
6607 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == VECTOR_TYPE
6608 && TREE_TYPE (exp) == TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6609 && tree_int_cst_equal (size_tree, TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
6610 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6612 else
6614 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6615 *punsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6617 if (mode == BLKmode)
6618 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6619 else
6620 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6623 if (size_tree != 0)
6625 if (! host_integerp (size_tree, 1))
6626 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
6627 else
6628 *pbitsize = tree_low_cst (size_tree, 1);
6631 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
6632 and find the ultimate containing object. */
6633 while (1)
6635 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6637 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6638 bit_offset += tree_to_double_int (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
6639 break;
6641 case COMPONENT_REF:
6643 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6644 tree this_offset = component_ref_field_offset (exp);
6646 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go past it.
6647 This should only happen when folding expressions made during
6648 type construction. */
6649 if (this_offset == 0)
6650 break;
6652 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
6653 bit_offset += tree_to_double_int (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field));
6655 /* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
6657 break;
6659 case ARRAY_REF:
6660 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6662 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6663 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
6664 tree unit_size = array_ref_element_size (exp);
6666 /* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
6667 First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
6668 index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of
6669 the array element. */
6670 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
6671 index = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6672 index, low_bound);
6674 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
6675 size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
6676 fold_convert (sizetype, index),
6677 unit_size));
6679 break;
6681 case REALPART_EXPR:
6682 break;
6684 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
6685 bit_offset += double_int::from_uhwi (*pbitsize);
6686 break;
6688 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6689 if (keep_aligning && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
6690 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6691 > TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
6692 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6693 < BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
6694 && (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6695 || TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
6696 goto done;
6697 break;
6699 case MEM_REF:
6700 /* Hand back the decl for MEM[&decl, off]. */
6701 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR)
6703 tree off = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6704 if (!integer_zerop (off))
6706 double_int boff, coff = mem_ref_offset (exp);
6707 boff = coff.lshift (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6708 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT));
6709 bit_offset += boff;
6711 exp = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6713 goto done;
6715 default:
6716 goto done;
6719 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
6720 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
6721 *pvolatilep = 1;
6723 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6725 done:
6727 /* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
6728 constant bit position. Make sure to handle overflow during
6729 this conversion. */
6730 if (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST)
6732 double_int tem = tree_to_double_int (offset);
6733 tem = tem.sext (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype));
6734 tem = tem.lshift (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT));
6735 tem += bit_offset;
6736 if (tem.fits_shwi ())
6738 *pbitpos = tem.to_shwi ();
6739 *poffset = offset = NULL_TREE;
6743 /* Otherwise, split it up. */
6744 if (offset)
6746 /* Avoid returning a negative bitpos as this may wreak havoc later. */
6747 if (bit_offset.is_negative ())
6749 double_int mask
6750 = double_int::mask (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6751 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT));
6752 double_int tem = bit_offset.and_not (mask);
6753 /* TEM is the bitpos rounded to BITS_PER_UNIT towards -Inf.
6754 Subtract it to BIT_OFFSET and add it (scaled) to OFFSET. */
6755 bit_offset -= tem;
6756 tem = tem.arshift (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6757 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT),
6758 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT);
6759 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
6760 double_int_to_tree (sizetype, tem));
6763 *pbitpos = bit_offset.to_shwi ();
6764 *poffset = offset;
6767 /* We can use BLKmode for a byte-aligned BLKmode bitfield. */
6768 if (mode == VOIDmode
6769 && blkmode_bitfield
6770 && (*pbitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
6771 && (*pbitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)
6772 *pmode = BLKmode;
6773 else
6774 *pmode = mode;
6776 return exp;
6779 /* Return a tree of sizetype representing the size, in bytes, of the element
6780 of EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6782 tree
6783 array_ref_element_size (tree exp)
6785 tree aligned_size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 3);
6786 tree elmt_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6787 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6789 /* If a size was specified in the ARRAY_REF, it's the size measured
6790 in alignment units of the element type. So multiply by that value. */
6791 if (aligned_size)
6793 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
6794 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
6795 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_size) != sizetype)
6796 aligned_size = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_size);
6797 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_size,
6798 size_int (TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (elmt_type)));
6801 /* Otherwise, take the size from that of the element type. Substitute
6802 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
6803 else
6804 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elmt_type), exp);
6807 /* Return a tree representing the lower bound of the array mentioned in
6808 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6810 tree
6811 array_ref_low_bound (tree exp)
6813 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6815 /* If a lower bound is specified in EXP, use it. */
6816 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))
6817 return TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
6819 /* Otherwise, if there is a domain type and it has a lower bound, use it,
6820 substituting for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
6821 if (domain_type && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type))
6822 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
6824 /* Otherwise, return a zero of the appropriate type. */
6825 return build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)), 0);
6828 /* Returns true if REF is an array reference to an array at the end of
6829 a structure. If this is the case, the array may be allocated larger
6830 than its upper bound implies. */
6832 bool
6833 array_at_struct_end_p (tree ref)
6835 if (TREE_CODE (ref) != ARRAY_REF
6836 && TREE_CODE (ref) != ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
6837 return false;
6839 while (handled_component_p (ref))
6841 /* If the reference chain contains a component reference to a
6842 non-union type and there follows another field the reference
6843 is not at the end of a structure. */
6844 if (TREE_CODE (ref) == COMPONENT_REF
6845 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0))) == RECORD_TYPE)
6847 tree nextf = DECL_CHAIN (TREE_OPERAND (ref, 1));
6848 while (nextf && TREE_CODE (nextf) != FIELD_DECL)
6849 nextf = DECL_CHAIN (nextf);
6850 if (nextf)
6851 return false;
6854 ref = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
6857 /* If the reference is based on a declared entity, the size of the array
6858 is constrained by its given domain. */
6859 if (DECL_P (ref))
6860 return false;
6862 return true;
6865 /* Return a tree representing the upper bound of the array mentioned in
6866 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6868 tree
6869 array_ref_up_bound (tree exp)
6871 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6873 /* If there is a domain type and it has an upper bound, use it, substituting
6874 for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
6875 if (domain_type && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type))
6876 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
6878 /* Otherwise fail. */
6879 return NULL_TREE;
6882 /* Return a tree representing the offset, in bytes, of the field referenced
6883 by EXP. This does not include any offset in DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET. */
6885 tree
6886 component_ref_field_offset (tree exp)
6888 tree aligned_offset = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
6889 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6890 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6892 /* If an offset was specified in the COMPONENT_REF, it's the offset measured
6893 in units of DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN / BITS_PER_UNIT. So multiply by that
6894 value. */
6895 if (aligned_offset)
6897 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
6898 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
6899 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_offset) != sizetype)
6900 aligned_offset = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_offset);
6901 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_offset,
6902 size_int (DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN (field)
6903 / BITS_PER_UNIT));
6906 /* Otherwise, take the offset from that of the field. Substitute
6907 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
6908 else
6909 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), exp);
6912 /* Alignment in bits the TARGET of an assignment may be assumed to have. */
6914 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6915 target_align (const_tree target)
6917 /* We might have a chain of nested references with intermediate misaligning
6918 bitfields components, so need to recurse to find out. */
6920 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT this_align, outer_align;
6922 switch (TREE_CODE (target))
6924 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6925 return 1;
6927 case COMPONENT_REF:
6928 this_align = DECL_ALIGN (TREE_OPERAND (target, 1));
6929 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6930 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
6932 case ARRAY_REF:
6933 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6934 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6935 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6936 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
6938 CASE_CONVERT:
6939 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
6940 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6941 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6942 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6943 return MAX (this_align, outer_align);
6945 default:
6946 return TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6951 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
6952 an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
6953 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
6954 returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
6956 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
6959 force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
6961 rtx op1, op2;
6962 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
6963 rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
6964 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
6966 /* Check for subreg applied to an expression produced by loop optimizer. */
6967 if (code == SUBREG
6968 && !REG_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
6969 && !MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
6971 value
6972 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
6973 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6974 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
6975 NULL_RTX)),
6976 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6977 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
6978 code = GET_CODE (value);
6981 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
6982 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
6983 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
6984 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
6985 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
6986 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
6988 if (!subtarget)
6989 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
6990 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
6991 return subtarget;
6994 if (ARITHMETIC_P (value))
6996 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
6997 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(REG_P (op2) && op2 != subtarget))
6998 subtarget = 0;
6999 if (code == MINUS && CONST_INT_P (op2))
7001 code = PLUS;
7002 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
7005 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
7006 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
7007 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
7008 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
7009 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
7010 creating another one around this addition. */
7011 if (code == PLUS && CONST_INT_P (op2)
7012 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
7013 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0))
7014 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
7015 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
7017 rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
7018 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
7019 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7020 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
7021 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
7022 0), 1), 0),
7023 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7026 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
7027 op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
7028 switch (code)
7030 case MULT:
7031 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
7032 case DIV:
7033 if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
7034 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7035 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7036 else
7037 return expand_divmod (0,
7038 FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
7039 ? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
7040 GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
7041 case MOD:
7042 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7043 target, 0);
7044 case UDIV:
7045 return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7046 target, 1);
7047 case UMOD:
7048 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7049 target, 1);
7050 case ASHIFTRT:
7051 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7052 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7053 default:
7054 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7055 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7058 if (UNARY_P (value))
7060 if (!target)
7061 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
7062 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
7063 switch (code)
7065 case ZERO_EXTEND:
7066 case SIGN_EXTEND:
7067 case TRUNCATE:
7068 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
7069 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
7070 convert_move (target, op1, code == ZERO_EXTEND);
7071 return target;
7073 case FIX:
7074 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
7075 expand_fix (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FIX);
7076 return target;
7078 case FLOAT:
7079 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
7080 expand_float (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
7081 return target;
7083 default:
7084 return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
7088 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
7089 /* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
7090 explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
7091 if (paradoxical_subreg_p (value) && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
7092 value
7093 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
7094 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7095 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
7096 NULL_RTX)),
7097 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7098 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
7099 #endif
7101 return value;
7104 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
7105 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
7106 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
7107 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
7109 It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
7110 searches for optimization opportunities. */
7113 safe_from_p (const_rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
7115 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
7116 int i, nops;
7118 if (x == 0
7119 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
7120 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
7121 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
7122 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
7123 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
7124 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
7125 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7126 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
7127 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
7128 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
7129 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7130 != INTEGER_CST)
7131 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
7132 /* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
7133 || (MEM_P (x)
7134 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
7135 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
7136 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
7137 return 1;
7139 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
7140 find the underlying pseudo. */
7141 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
7143 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
7144 if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7145 return 0;
7148 /* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
7149 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
7151 case tcc_declaration:
7152 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
7153 break;
7155 case tcc_constant:
7156 return 1;
7158 case tcc_exceptional:
7159 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
7161 while (1)
7163 if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
7164 return 0;
7165 exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
7166 if (!exp)
7167 return 1;
7168 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
7169 return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
7172 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7174 constructor_elt *ce;
7175 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
7177 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce)
7178 if ((ce->index != NULL_TREE && !safe_from_p (x, ce->index, 0))
7179 || !safe_from_p (x, ce->value, 0))
7180 return 0;
7181 return 1;
7183 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
7184 return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
7185 else
7186 return 0;
7188 case tcc_statement:
7189 /* The only case we look at here is the DECL_INITIAL inside a
7190 DECL_EXPR. */
7191 return (TREE_CODE (exp) != DECL_EXPR
7192 || TREE_CODE (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)) != VAR_DECL
7193 || !DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp))
7194 || safe_from_p (x, DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)), 0));
7196 case tcc_binary:
7197 case tcc_comparison:
7198 if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
7199 return 0;
7200 /* Fall through. */
7202 case tcc_unary:
7203 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7205 case tcc_expression:
7206 case tcc_reference:
7207 case tcc_vl_exp:
7208 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
7209 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
7210 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
7211 expression recursively. */
7213 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7215 case ADDR_EXPR:
7216 /* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
7217 Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
7218 if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
7219 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
7220 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7221 return 1;
7223 /* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
7224 the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
7225 very rare. */
7226 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7227 if (DECL_P (exp))
7229 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
7230 || !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp)))
7231 return 0;
7232 else
7233 exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
7235 break;
7237 case MEM_REF:
7238 if (MEM_P (x)
7239 && alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
7240 get_alias_set (exp)))
7241 return 0;
7242 break;
7244 case CALL_EXPR:
7245 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
7246 all of memory. */
7247 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7248 || MEM_P (x))
7249 return 0;
7250 break;
7252 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
7253 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
7254 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
7255 gcc_unreachable ();
7257 case SAVE_EXPR:
7258 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7260 default:
7261 break;
7264 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
7265 if (exp_rtl)
7266 break;
7268 nops = TREE_OPERAND_LENGTH (exp);
7269 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
7270 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
7271 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
7272 return 0;
7274 break;
7276 case tcc_type:
7277 /* Should never get a type here. */
7278 gcc_unreachable ();
7281 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
7282 with it. */
7283 if (exp_rtl)
7285 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
7287 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
7288 if (REG_P (exp_rtl)
7289 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7290 return 0;
7293 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
7294 are memory and they conflict. */
7295 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
7296 || (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (exp_rtl)
7297 && true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x)));
7300 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
7301 return 1;
7305 /* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
7306 This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
7308 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7309 highest_pow2_factor (const_tree exp)
7311 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c0, c1;
7313 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7315 case INTEGER_CST:
7316 /* We can find the lowest bit that's a one. If the low
7317 HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT bits are zero, return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.
7318 We need to handle this case since we can find it in a COND_EXPR,
7319 a MIN_EXPR, or a MAX_EXPR. If the constant overflows, we have an
7320 erroneous program, so return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT to avoid any
7321 later ICE. */
7322 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (exp))
7323 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7324 else
7326 /* Note: tree_low_cst is intentionally not used here,
7327 we don't care about the upper bits. */
7328 c0 = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp);
7329 c0 &= -c0;
7330 return c0 ? c0 : BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7332 break;
7334 case PLUS_EXPR: case MINUS_EXPR: case MIN_EXPR: case MAX_EXPR:
7335 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7336 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7337 return MIN (c0, c1);
7339 case MULT_EXPR:
7340 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7341 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7342 return c0 * c1;
7344 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR: case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR: case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
7345 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
7346 if (integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7347 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7349 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7350 c1 = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1);
7351 return MAX (1, c0 / c1);
7353 break;
7355 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
7356 /* The highest power of two of a bit-and expression is the maximum of
7357 that of its operands. We typically get here for a complex LHS and
7358 a constant negative power of two on the RHS to force an explicit
7359 alignment, so don't bother looking at the LHS. */
7360 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7362 CASE_CONVERT:
7363 case SAVE_EXPR:
7364 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7366 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
7367 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7369 case COND_EXPR:
7370 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7371 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
7372 return MIN (c0, c1);
7374 default:
7375 break;
7378 return 1;
7381 /* Similar, except that the alignment requirements of TARGET are
7382 taken into account. Assume it is at least as aligned as its
7383 type, unless it is a COMPONENT_REF in which case the layout of
7384 the structure gives the alignment. */
7386 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7387 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree target, const_tree exp)
7389 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT talign = target_align (target) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
7390 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
7392 return MAX (factor, talign);
7395 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
7396 /* Convert the tree comparison code TCODE to the rtl one where the
7397 signedness is UNSIGNEDP. */
7399 static enum rtx_code
7400 convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (enum tree_code tcode, int unsignedp)
7402 enum rtx_code code;
7403 switch (tcode)
7405 case EQ_EXPR:
7406 code = EQ;
7407 break;
7408 case NE_EXPR:
7409 code = NE;
7410 break;
7411 case LT_EXPR:
7412 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
7413 break;
7414 case LE_EXPR:
7415 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
7416 break;
7417 case GT_EXPR:
7418 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
7419 break;
7420 case GE_EXPR:
7421 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
7422 break;
7423 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
7424 code = UNORDERED;
7425 break;
7426 case ORDERED_EXPR:
7427 code = ORDERED;
7428 break;
7429 case UNLT_EXPR:
7430 code = UNLT;
7431 break;
7432 case UNLE_EXPR:
7433 code = UNLE;
7434 break;
7435 case UNGT_EXPR:
7436 code = UNGT;
7437 break;
7438 case UNGE_EXPR:
7439 code = UNGE;
7440 break;
7441 case UNEQ_EXPR:
7442 code = UNEQ;
7443 break;
7444 case LTGT_EXPR:
7445 code = LTGT;
7446 break;
7448 default:
7449 gcc_unreachable ();
7451 return code;
7453 #endif
7455 /* Subroutine of expand_expr. Expand the two operands of a binary
7456 expression EXP0 and EXP1 placing the results in OP0 and OP1.
7457 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero. The
7458 MODIFIER argument is as documented by expand_expr. */
7460 static void
7461 expand_operands (tree exp0, tree exp1, rtx target, rtx *op0, rtx *op1,
7462 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7464 if (! safe_from_p (target, exp1, 1))
7465 target = 0;
7466 if (operand_equal_p (exp0, exp1, 0))
7468 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7469 *op1 = copy_rtx (*op0);
7471 else
7473 /* If we need to preserve evaluation order, copy exp0 into its own
7474 temporary variable so that it can't be clobbered by exp1. */
7475 if (flag_evaluation_order && TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp1))
7476 exp0 = save_expr (exp0);
7477 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7478 *op1 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
7483 /* Return a MEM that contains constant EXP. DEFER is as for
7484 output_constant_def and MODIFIER is as for expand_expr. */
7486 static rtx
7487 expand_expr_constant (tree exp, int defer, enum expand_modifier modifier)
7489 rtx mem;
7491 mem = output_constant_def (exp, defer);
7492 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7493 mem = use_anchored_address (mem);
7494 return mem;
7497 /* A subroutine of expand_expr_addr_expr. Evaluate the address of EXP.
7498 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7500 static rtx
7501 expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7502 enum expand_modifier modifier, addr_space_t as)
7504 rtx result, subtarget;
7505 tree inner, offset;
7506 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
7507 int volatilep, unsignedp;
7508 enum machine_mode mode1;
7510 /* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the top level,
7511 we have to use output_constant_def since we can't call force_const_mem
7512 at top level. */
7513 /* ??? This should be considered a front-end bug. We should not be
7514 generating ADDR_EXPR of something that isn't an LVALUE. The only
7515 exception here is STRING_CST. */
7516 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (exp))
7518 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (exp, 0, modifier), 0);
7519 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7520 result = force_operand (result, target);
7521 return result;
7524 /* Everything must be something allowed by is_gimple_addressable. */
7525 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7527 case INDIRECT_REF:
7528 /* This case will happen via recursion for &a->b. */
7529 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
7531 case MEM_REF:
7533 tree tem = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7534 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
7535 tem = fold_build_pointer_plus (tem, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7536 return expand_expr (tem, target, tmode, modifier);
7539 case CONST_DECL:
7540 /* Expand the initializer like constants above. */
7541 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (DECL_INITIAL (exp),
7542 0, modifier), 0);
7543 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7544 result = force_operand (result, target);
7545 return result;
7547 case REALPART_EXPR:
7548 /* The real part of the complex number is always first, therefore
7549 the address is the same as the address of the parent object. */
7550 offset = 0;
7551 bitpos = 0;
7552 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7553 break;
7555 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
7556 /* The imaginary part of the complex number is always second.
7557 The expression is therefore always offset by the size of the
7558 scalar type. */
7559 offset = 0;
7560 bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7561 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7562 break;
7564 default:
7565 /* If the object is a DECL, then expand it for its rtl. Don't bypass
7566 expand_expr, as that can have various side effects; LABEL_DECLs for
7567 example, may not have their DECL_RTL set yet. Expand the rtl of
7568 CONSTRUCTORs too, which should yield a memory reference for the
7569 constructor's contents. Assume language specific tree nodes can
7570 be expanded in some interesting way. */
7571 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) < LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE);
7572 if (DECL_P (exp)
7573 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
7574 || TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR)
7576 result = expand_expr (exp, target, tmode,
7577 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7578 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
7580 /* If the DECL isn't in memory, then the DECL wasn't properly
7581 marked TREE_ADDRESSABLE, which will be either a front-end
7582 or a tree optimizer bug. */
7584 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7585 && ! MEM_P (result)
7586 && ! targetm.calls.allocate_stack_slots_for_args())
7588 error ("local frame unavailable (naked function?)");
7589 return result;
7591 else
7592 gcc_assert (MEM_P (result));
7593 result = XEXP (result, 0);
7595 /* ??? Is this needed anymore? */
7596 if (DECL_P (exp))
7597 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
7599 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7600 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7601 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7602 result = force_operand (result, target);
7603 return result;
7606 /* Pass FALSE as the last argument to get_inner_reference although
7607 we are expanding to RTL. The rationale is that we know how to
7608 handle "aligning nodes" here: we can just bypass them because
7609 they won't change the final object whose address will be returned
7610 (they actually exist only for that purpose). */
7611 inner = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
7612 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
7613 break;
7616 /* We must have made progress. */
7617 gcc_assert (inner != exp);
7619 subtarget = offset || bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
7620 /* For VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, where the outer alignment is bigger than
7621 inner alignment, force the inner to be sufficiently aligned. */
7622 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (inner)
7623 && TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) < TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7625 inner = copy_node (inner);
7626 TREE_TYPE (inner) = copy_node (TREE_TYPE (inner));
7627 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7628 TYPE_USER_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = 1;
7630 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (inner, subtarget, tmode, modifier, as);
7632 if (offset)
7634 rtx tmp;
7636 if (modifier != EXPAND_NORMAL)
7637 result = force_operand (result, NULL);
7638 tmp = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, tmode,
7639 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7640 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_NORMAL);
7642 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7643 tmp = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, tmp, as);
7645 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7646 result = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, tmode, result, tmp);
7647 else
7649 subtarget = bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
7650 result = expand_simple_binop (tmode, PLUS, result, tmp, subtarget,
7651 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7655 if (bitpos)
7657 /* Someone beforehand should have rejected taking the address
7658 of such an object. */
7659 gcc_assert ((bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
7661 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7662 result = plus_constant (tmode, result, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7663 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7664 result = force_operand (result, target);
7667 return result;
7670 /* A subroutine of expand_expr. Evaluate EXP, which is an ADDR_EXPR.
7671 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7673 static rtx
7674 expand_expr_addr_expr (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7675 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7677 addr_space_t as = ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC;
7678 enum machine_mode address_mode = Pmode;
7679 enum machine_mode pointer_mode = ptr_mode;
7680 enum machine_mode rmode;
7681 rtx result;
7683 /* Target mode of VOIDmode says "whatever's natural". */
7684 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
7685 tmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7687 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7689 as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7690 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
7691 pointer_mode = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (as);
7694 /* We can get called with some Weird Things if the user does silliness
7695 like "(short) &a". In that case, convert_memory_address won't do
7696 the right thing, so ignore the given target mode. */
7697 if (tmode != address_mode && tmode != pointer_mode)
7698 tmode = address_mode;
7700 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
7701 tmode, modifier, as);
7703 /* Despite expand_expr claims concerning ignoring TMODE when not
7704 strictly convenient, stuff breaks if we don't honor it. Note
7705 that combined with the above, we only do this for pointer modes. */
7706 rmode = GET_MODE (result);
7707 if (rmode == VOIDmode)
7708 rmode = tmode;
7709 if (rmode != tmode)
7710 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7712 return result;
7715 /* Generate code for computing CONSTRUCTOR EXP.
7716 An rtx for the computed value is returned. If AVOID_TEMP_MEM
7717 is TRUE, instead of creating a temporary variable in memory
7718 NULL is returned and the caller needs to handle it differently. */
7720 static rtx
7721 expand_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, enum expand_modifier modifier,
7722 bool avoid_temp_mem)
7724 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
7725 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7727 /* Try to avoid creating a temporary at all. This is possible
7728 if all of the initializer is zero.
7729 FIXME: try to handle all [0..255] initializers we can handle
7730 with memset. */
7731 if (TREE_STATIC (exp)
7732 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7733 && target != 0 && mode == BLKmode
7734 && all_zeros_p (exp))
7736 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7737 return target;
7740 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
7741 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
7742 since that should make a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE when we
7743 fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can use, it is best to
7744 store directly into the target unless the type is large enough
7745 that memcpy will be used. If we are making an initializer and
7746 all operands are constant, put it in memory as well.
7748 FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
7749 Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
7750 they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
7751 are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays. */
7752 if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
7753 && ((mode == BLKmode
7754 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
7755 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7756 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1)
7757 && (! MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
7758 (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1),
7759 TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
7760 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
7761 || ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
7762 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
7764 rtx constructor;
7766 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7767 return NULL_RTX;
7769 constructor = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
7771 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7772 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7773 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7774 constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
7776 return constructor;
7779 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
7780 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
7781 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
7782 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7784 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7785 return NULL_RTX;
7787 target
7788 = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type, (TYPE_QUALS (type)
7789 | (TREE_READONLY (exp)
7790 * TYPE_QUAL_CONST))),
7791 TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
7794 store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp));
7795 return target;
7799 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
7800 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
7801 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
7803 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
7804 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7805 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
7807 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
7809 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
7810 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
7811 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
7812 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7813 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
7815 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
7816 probably will not be used.
7818 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
7819 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
7820 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
7821 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
7822 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
7823 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
7825 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
7826 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
7827 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
7828 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
7830 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
7831 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
7832 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
7834 EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
7835 a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
7836 marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
7837 don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
7838 Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
7839 emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM.
7841 If EXP is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL was a MEM with an invalid
7842 address, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL, then *ALT_RTL is set to the
7843 DECL_RTL of the VAR_DECL. *ALT_RTL is also set if EXP is a
7844 COMPOUND_EXPR whose second argument is such a VAR_DECL, and so on
7845 recursively. */
7848 expand_expr_real (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7849 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
7851 rtx ret;
7853 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
7854 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK
7855 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == ERROR_MARK))
7857 ret = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
7858 return ret ? ret : const0_rtx;
7861 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
7862 return ret;
7865 /* Try to expand the conditional expression which is represented by
7866 TREEOP0 ? TREEOP1 : TREEOP2 using conditonal moves. If succeseds
7867 return the rtl reg which repsents the result. Otherwise return
7868 NULL_RTL. */
7870 static rtx
7871 expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (tree treeop0 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7872 tree treeop1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7873 tree treeop2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7875 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
7876 rtx insn;
7877 rtx op00, op01, op1, op2;
7878 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
7879 enum machine_mode comparison_mode;
7880 gimple srcstmt;
7881 rtx temp;
7882 tree type = TREE_TYPE (treeop1);
7883 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7884 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7885 enum machine_mode orig_mode = mode;
7887 /* If we cannot do a conditional move on the mode, try doing it
7888 with the promoted mode. */
7889 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
7891 mode = promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp);
7892 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
7893 return NULL_RTX;
7894 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0); /* Use promoted mode for temp. */
7896 else
7897 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
7899 start_sequence ();
7900 expand_operands (treeop1, treeop2,
7901 temp, &op1, &op2, EXPAND_NORMAL);
7903 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == SSA_NAME
7904 && (srcstmt = get_def_for_expr_class (treeop0, tcc_comparison)))
7906 tree type = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
7907 enum tree_code cmpcode = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
7908 op00 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
7909 op01 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
7910 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7911 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7912 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
7914 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (treeop0)) == tcc_comparison)
7916 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
7917 enum tree_code cmpcode = TREE_CODE (treeop0);
7918 op00 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
7919 op01 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1));
7920 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7921 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7922 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
7924 else
7926 op00 = expand_normal (treeop0);
7927 op01 = const0_rtx;
7928 comparison_code = NE;
7929 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
7932 if (GET_MODE (op1) != mode)
7933 op1 = gen_lowpart (mode, op1);
7935 if (GET_MODE (op2) != mode)
7936 op2 = gen_lowpart (mode, op2);
7938 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
7939 insn = emit_conditional_move (temp, comparison_code,
7940 op00, op01, comparison_mode,
7941 op1, op2, mode,
7942 unsignedp);
7944 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
7945 and return. */
7946 if (insn)
7948 rtx seq = get_insns ();
7949 end_sequence ();
7950 emit_insn (seq);
7951 return convert_modes (orig_mode, mode, temp, 0);
7954 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
7955 branches. */
7956 end_sequence ();
7957 #endif
7958 return NULL_RTX;
7962 expand_expr_real_2 (sepops ops, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7963 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7965 rtx op0, op1, op2, temp;
7966 tree type;
7967 int unsignedp;
7968 enum machine_mode mode;
7969 enum tree_code code = ops->code;
7970 optab this_optab;
7971 rtx subtarget, original_target;
7972 int ignore;
7973 bool reduce_bit_field;
7974 location_t loc = ops->location;
7975 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
7976 #define REDUCE_BIT_FIELD(expr) (reduce_bit_field \
7977 ? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), \
7978 target, \
7979 type) \
7980 : (expr))
7982 type = ops->type;
7983 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7984 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7986 treeop0 = ops->op0;
7987 treeop1 = ops->op1;
7988 treeop2 = ops->op2;
7990 /* We should be called only on simple (binary or unary) expressions,
7991 exactly those that are valid in gimple expressions that aren't
7992 GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS (or invalid). */
7993 gcc_assert (get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS
7994 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS
7995 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS);
7997 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
7998 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
7999 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
8000 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
8002 /* We should be called only if we need the result. */
8003 gcc_assert (!ignore);
8005 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
8006 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
8007 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
8008 reduce_bit_field = (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
8009 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
8011 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8012 target = 0;
8014 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
8015 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
8016 original_target = target;
8018 switch (code)
8020 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
8021 case PAREN_EXPR:
8022 CASE_CONVERT:
8023 if (treeop0 == error_mark_node)
8024 return const0_rtx;
8026 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
8028 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8030 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
8031 anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
8032 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
8034 rtx result = expand_expr (treeop0, target, tmode,
8035 modifier);
8037 result = copy_rtx (result);
8038 set_mem_attributes (result, type, 0);
8039 return result;
8042 if (target == 0)
8044 if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode)
8045 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
8046 else
8047 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
8050 if (MEM_P (target))
8051 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
8052 store_expr (treeop0,
8053 adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
8054 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
8055 false);
8057 else
8059 gcc_assert (REG_P (target));
8061 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
8062 store_field (target,
8063 MIN ((int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE
8064 (treeop0))
8065 * BITS_PER_UNIT),
8066 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)),
8067 0, 0, 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), treeop0, 0, false);
8070 /* Return the entire union. */
8071 return target;
8074 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8076 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, target, VOIDmode,
8077 modifier);
8079 /* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
8080 a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
8081 have to do the proper extension. */
8082 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != unsignedp
8083 && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
8084 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
8086 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8089 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, mode,
8090 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier);
8091 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
8094 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
8095 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
8097 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8098 enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (op0);
8100 if (inner_mode == VOIDmode)
8101 inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
8103 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8104 op0 = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode,
8105 subreg_lowpart_offset (mode,
8106 inner_mode));
8107 else
8108 op0= convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
8109 TYPE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
8112 else if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8113 op0 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
8115 else if (target == 0)
8116 op0 = convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
8117 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
8118 (treeop0)));
8119 else
8121 convert_move (target, op0,
8122 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8123 op0 = target;
8126 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8128 case ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT_EXPR:
8130 tree treeop0_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8131 addr_space_t as_to;
8132 addr_space_t as_from;
8134 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (type));
8135 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (treeop0_type));
8137 as_to = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (type));
8138 as_from = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0_type));
8140 /* Conversions between pointers to the same address space should
8141 have been implemented via CONVERT_EXPR / NOP_EXPR. */
8142 gcc_assert (as_to != as_from);
8144 /* Ask target code to handle conversion between pointers
8145 to overlapping address spaces. */
8146 if (targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_to, as_from)
8147 || targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_from, as_to))
8149 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
8150 op0 = targetm.addr_space.convert (op0, treeop0_type, type);
8151 gcc_assert (op0);
8152 return op0;
8155 /* For disjoint address spaces, converting anything but
8156 a null pointer invokes undefined behaviour. We simply
8157 always return a null pointer here. */
8158 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
8161 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
8162 /* Even though the sizetype mode and the pointer's mode can be different
8163 expand is able to handle this correctly and get the correct result out
8164 of the PLUS_EXPR code. */
8165 /* Make sure to sign-extend the sizetype offset in a POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
8166 if sizetype precision is smaller than pointer precision. */
8167 if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) < TYPE_PRECISION (type))
8168 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type,
8169 fold_convert_loc (loc, ssizetype,
8170 treeop1));
8171 /* If sizetype precision is larger than pointer precision, truncate the
8172 offset to have matching modes. */
8173 else if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) > TYPE_PRECISION (type))
8174 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type, treeop1);
8176 case PLUS_EXPR:
8177 /* If we are adding a constant, a VAR_DECL that is sp, fp, or ap, and
8178 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
8179 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
8180 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
8181 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
8183 fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
8184 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
8185 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
8186 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
8188 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == PLUS_EXPR
8189 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8190 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == VAR_DECL
8191 && (DECL_RTL (treeop1) == frame_pointer_rtx
8192 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == stack_pointer_rtx
8193 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == arg_pointer_rtx))
8195 gcc_unreachable ();
8198 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
8199 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
8200 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
8201 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
8202 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
8203 address.
8205 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
8206 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8207 || (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
8209 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8210 target = 0;
8211 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST
8212 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8213 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop1))
8215 rtx constant_part;
8217 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8218 EXPAND_SUM);
8219 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
8220 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8221 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8222 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8223 constant_part
8224 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop0),
8225 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
8226 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
8227 op1 = plus_constant (mode, op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
8228 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8229 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
8230 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op1);
8233 else if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8234 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8235 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop0))
8237 rtx constant_part;
8239 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8240 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8241 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
8242 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
8244 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, NULL_RTX,
8245 VOIDmode, modifier);
8246 /* Return a PLUS if modifier says it's OK. */
8247 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM
8248 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8249 return simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
8250 goto binop2;
8252 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
8253 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8254 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8255 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8256 constant_part
8257 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1),
8258 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
8259 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8260 op0 = plus_constant (mode, op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
8261 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8262 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
8263 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8267 /* Use TER to expand pointer addition of a negated value
8268 as pointer subtraction. */
8269 if ((POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8270 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == VECTOR_TYPE
8271 && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))))
8272 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == SSA_NAME
8273 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8274 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)))
8276 gimple def = get_def_for_expr (treeop1, NEGATE_EXPR);
8277 if (def)
8279 treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def);
8280 code = MINUS_EXPR;
8281 goto do_minus;
8285 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8286 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8287 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8288 zero-extend. */
8289 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8290 || mode != ptr_mode)
8292 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8293 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8294 if (op0 == const0_rtx)
8295 return op1;
8296 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
8297 return op0;
8298 goto binop2;
8301 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8302 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8303 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8305 case MINUS_EXPR:
8306 do_minus:
8307 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
8308 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
8309 are constant. */
8310 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
8311 for the sake of an initializer. */
8312 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8313 && really_constant_p (treeop0)
8314 && really_constant_p (treeop1))
8316 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8317 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8319 /* If the last operand is a CONST_INT, use plus_constant of
8320 the negated constant. Else make the MINUS. */
8321 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
8322 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (plus_constant (mode, op0,
8323 -INTVAL (op1)));
8324 else
8325 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, op0, op1));
8328 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8329 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8330 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8331 zero-extend. */
8332 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8333 || mode != ptr_mode)
8334 goto binop;
8336 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8337 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8339 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
8340 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
8342 op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
8343 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8346 goto binop2;
8348 case WIDEN_MULT_PLUS_EXPR:
8349 case WIDEN_MULT_MINUS_EXPR:
8350 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8351 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8352 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
8353 target, unsignedp);
8354 return target;
8356 case WIDEN_MULT_EXPR:
8357 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8358 Thus the following special case checks need only
8359 check the second operand. */
8360 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
8362 tree t1 = treeop0;
8363 treeop0 = treeop1;
8364 treeop1 = t1;
8367 /* First, check if we have a multiplication of one signed and one
8368 unsigned operand. */
8369 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) != INTEGER_CST
8370 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8371 != TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))))
8373 enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8374 this_optab = usmul_widen_optab;
8375 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8376 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8378 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8379 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8380 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8381 else
8382 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op1, &op0,
8383 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8384 goto binop3;
8387 /* Check for a multiplication with matching signedness. */
8388 else if ((TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8389 && int_fits_type_p (treeop1, TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8390 || (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))
8391 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))))
8393 tree op0type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8394 enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (op0type);
8395 bool zextend_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (op0type);
8396 optab other_optab = zextend_p ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab;
8397 this_optab = zextend_p ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab;
8399 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) != INTEGER_CST)
8401 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8402 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8404 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8405 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8406 temp = expand_widening_mult (mode, op0, op1, target,
8407 unsignedp, this_optab);
8408 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8410 if (find_widening_optab_handler (other_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8411 != CODE_FOR_nothing
8412 && innermode == word_mode)
8414 rtx htem, hipart;
8415 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8416 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST)
8417 op1 = convert_modes (innermode, mode,
8418 expand_normal (treeop1), unsignedp);
8419 else
8420 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8421 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
8422 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8423 hipart = gen_highpart (innermode, temp);
8424 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (innermode, hipart,
8425 op0, op1, hipart,
8426 zextend_p);
8427 if (htem != hipart)
8428 emit_move_insn (hipart, htem);
8429 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8433 treeop0 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop0);
8434 treeop1 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop1);
8435 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8436 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
8438 case FMA_EXPR:
8440 optab opt = fma_optab;
8441 gimple def0, def2;
8443 /* If there is no insn for FMA, emit it as __builtin_fma{,f,l}
8444 call. */
8445 if (optab_handler (fma_optab, mode) == CODE_FOR_nothing)
8447 tree fn = mathfn_built_in (TREE_TYPE (treeop0), BUILT_IN_FMA);
8448 tree call_expr;
8450 gcc_assert (fn != NULL_TREE);
8451 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2);
8452 return expand_builtin (call_expr, target, subtarget, mode, false);
8455 def0 = get_def_for_expr (treeop0, NEGATE_EXPR);
8456 def2 = get_def_for_expr (treeop2, NEGATE_EXPR);
8458 op0 = op2 = NULL;
8460 if (def0 && def2
8461 && optab_handler (fnms_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8463 opt = fnms_optab;
8464 op0 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def0));
8465 op2 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def2));
8467 else if (def0
8468 && optab_handler (fnma_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8470 opt = fnma_optab;
8471 op0 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def0));
8473 else if (def2
8474 && optab_handler (fms_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8476 opt = fms_optab;
8477 op2 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def2));
8480 if (op0 == NULL)
8481 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8482 if (op2 == NULL)
8483 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8484 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8486 return expand_ternary_op (TYPE_MODE (type), opt,
8487 op0, op1, op2, target, 0);
8490 case MULT_EXPR:
8491 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8492 below because "expand_mult" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8493 multiplications. */
8494 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8495 goto binop;
8497 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8498 Thus the following special case checks need only
8499 check the second operand. */
8500 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
8502 tree t1 = treeop0;
8503 treeop0 = treeop1;
8504 treeop1 = t1;
8507 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
8508 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
8510 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
8511 && host_integerp (treeop1, 0))
8513 tree exp1 = treeop1;
8515 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8516 EXPAND_SUM);
8518 if (!REG_P (op0))
8519 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
8520 if (!REG_P (op0))
8521 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
8523 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
8524 gen_int_mode (tree_low_cst (exp1, 0),
8525 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)))));
8528 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8529 target = 0;
8531 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8532 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
8534 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
8535 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
8536 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
8537 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
8538 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
8539 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8540 below because "expand_divmod" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8541 divisions. */
8542 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8543 goto binop;
8545 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8546 target = 0;
8547 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
8548 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
8549 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
8550 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8551 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8552 return expand_divmod (0, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8554 case RDIV_EXPR:
8555 goto binop;
8557 case MULT_HIGHPART_EXPR:
8558 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8559 temp = expand_mult_highpart (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8560 gcc_assert (temp);
8561 return temp;
8563 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
8564 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
8565 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
8566 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
8567 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8568 target = 0;
8569 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8570 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8571 return expand_divmod (1, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8573 case FIXED_CONVERT_EXPR:
8574 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8575 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8576 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8578 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == INTEGER_TYPE
8579 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8580 || (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)))
8581 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 1, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
8582 else
8583 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 0, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
8584 return target;
8586 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
8587 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8588 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8589 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8590 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
8591 return target;
8593 case FLOAT_EXPR:
8594 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8595 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8596 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8597 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
8598 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
8599 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
8600 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)),
8601 op0);
8602 expand_float (target, op0,
8603 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8604 return target;
8606 case NEGATE_EXPR:
8607 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8608 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8609 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8610 target = 0;
8611 temp = expand_unop (mode,
8612 optab_for_tree_code (NEGATE_EXPR, type,
8613 optab_default),
8614 op0, target, 0);
8615 gcc_assert (temp);
8616 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8618 case ABS_EXPR:
8619 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8620 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8621 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8622 target = 0;
8624 /* ABS_EXPR is not valid for complex arguments. */
8625 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
8626 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT);
8628 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
8629 risk generating incorrect code below. */
8630 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8631 return op0;
8633 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
8634 safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1));
8636 case MAX_EXPR:
8637 case MIN_EXPR:
8638 target = original_target;
8639 if (target == 0
8640 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8641 || (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
8642 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
8643 || (REG_P (target)
8644 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
8645 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8646 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8647 target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8649 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
8650 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
8651 value. */
8652 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8653 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
8654 OPTAB_WIDEN);
8655 if (temp != 0)
8656 return temp;
8658 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
8659 code without it. */
8661 if (! REG_P (target))
8662 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8664 /* If op1 was placed in target, swap op0 and op1. */
8665 if (target != op0 && target == op1)
8667 temp = op0;
8668 op0 = op1;
8669 op1 = temp;
8672 /* We generate better code and avoid problems with op1 mentioning
8673 target by forcing op1 into a pseudo if it isn't a constant. */
8674 if (! CONSTANT_P (op1))
8675 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
8678 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
8679 rtx cmpop1 = op1;
8681 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
8682 comparison_code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
8683 else
8684 comparison_code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
8686 /* Canonicalize to comparisons against 0. */
8687 if (op1 == const1_rtx)
8689 /* Converting (a >= 1 ? a : 1) into (a > 0 ? a : 1)
8690 or (a != 0 ? a : 1) for unsigned.
8691 For MIN we are safe converting (a <= 1 ? a : 1)
8692 into (a <= 0 ? a : 1) */
8693 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
8694 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
8695 comparison_code = unsignedp ? NE : GT;
8697 if (op1 == constm1_rtx && !unsignedp)
8699 /* Converting (a >= -1 ? a : -1) into (a >= 0 ? a : -1)
8700 and (a <= -1 ? a : -1) into (a < 0 ? a : -1) */
8701 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
8702 if (code == MIN_EXPR)
8703 comparison_code = LT;
8705 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
8706 /* Use a conditional move if possible. */
8707 if (can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
8709 rtx insn;
8711 /* ??? Same problem as in expmed.c: emit_conditional_move
8712 forces a stack adjustment via compare_from_rtx, and we
8713 lose the stack adjustment if the sequence we are about
8714 to create is discarded. */
8715 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8717 start_sequence ();
8719 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
8720 insn = emit_conditional_move (target, comparison_code,
8721 op0, cmpop1, mode,
8722 op0, op1, mode,
8723 unsignedp);
8725 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
8726 and return. */
8727 if (insn)
8729 rtx seq = get_insns ();
8730 end_sequence ();
8731 emit_insn (seq);
8732 return target;
8735 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
8736 branches. */
8737 end_sequence ();
8739 #endif
8740 if (target != op0)
8741 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
8743 temp = gen_label_rtx ();
8744 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, cmpop1, comparison_code,
8745 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, temp,
8746 -1);
8748 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
8749 emit_label (temp);
8750 return target;
8752 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
8753 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8754 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8755 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8756 target = 0;
8757 /* In case we have to reduce the result to bitfield precision
8758 for unsigned bitfield expand this as XOR with a proper constant
8759 instead. */
8760 if (reduce_bit_field && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8761 temp = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0,
8762 immed_double_int_const
8763 (double_int::mask (TYPE_PRECISION (type)), mode),
8764 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8765 else
8766 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
8767 gcc_assert (temp);
8768 return temp;
8770 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
8771 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
8772 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
8773 but that is probably not worth while. */
8775 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8776 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8777 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
8778 goto binop;
8780 case LROTATE_EXPR:
8781 case RROTATE_EXPR:
8782 gcc_assert (VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type))
8783 || (GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (type))
8784 == TYPE_PRECISION (type)));
8785 /* fall through */
8787 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
8788 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
8789 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8790 below because "expand_shift" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8791 shifts. */
8792 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8793 goto binop;
8795 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, treeop1, 1))
8796 subtarget = 0;
8797 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8798 target = 0;
8799 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8800 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8801 temp = expand_variable_shift (code, mode, op0, treeop1, target,
8802 unsignedp);
8803 if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR)
8804 temp = REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8805 return temp;
8807 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
8808 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
8809 case LT_EXPR:
8810 case LE_EXPR:
8811 case GT_EXPR:
8812 case GE_EXPR:
8813 case EQ_EXPR:
8814 case NE_EXPR:
8815 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
8816 case ORDERED_EXPR:
8817 case UNLT_EXPR:
8818 case UNLE_EXPR:
8819 case UNGT_EXPR:
8820 case UNGE_EXPR:
8821 case UNEQ_EXPR:
8822 case LTGT_EXPR:
8823 temp = do_store_flag (ops,
8824 modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
8825 tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
8826 if (temp)
8827 return temp;
8829 /* Use a compare and a jump for BLKmode comparisons, or for function
8830 type comparisons is HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare. */
8832 if ((target == 0
8833 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8834 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1)
8835 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop1, 1)
8836 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
8837 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
8838 || (!optimize && REG_P (target)
8839 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
8840 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
8842 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
8844 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
8845 jumpifnot_1 (code, treeop0, treeop1, op1, -1);
8847 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == 1 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8848 emit_move_insn (target, constm1_rtx);
8849 else
8850 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
8852 emit_label (op1);
8853 return target;
8855 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
8856 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
8857 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8858 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8860 if (!target)
8861 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
8862 else
8863 /* If target overlaps with op1, then either we need to force
8864 op1 into a pseudo (if target also overlaps with op0),
8865 or write the complex parts in reverse order. */
8866 switch (GET_CODE (target))
8868 case CONCAT:
8869 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (target, 0), op1))
8871 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (target, 1), op0))
8873 complex_expr_force_op1:
8874 temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target)));
8875 emit_move_insn (temp, op1);
8876 op1 = temp;
8877 break;
8879 complex_expr_swap_order:
8880 /* Move the imaginary (op1) and real (op0) parts to their
8881 location. */
8882 write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
8883 write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
8885 return target;
8887 break;
8888 case MEM:
8889 temp = adjust_address_nv (target,
8890 GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target)), 0);
8891 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (temp, op1))
8893 enum machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target));
8894 temp = adjust_address_nv (target, imode,
8895 GET_MODE_SIZE (imode));
8896 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (temp, op0))
8897 goto complex_expr_force_op1;
8898 goto complex_expr_swap_order;
8900 break;
8901 default:
8902 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (target, op1))
8904 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (target, op0))
8905 goto complex_expr_force_op1;
8906 goto complex_expr_swap_order;
8908 break;
8911 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
8912 write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
8913 write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
8915 return target;
8917 case WIDEN_SUM_EXPR:
8919 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8920 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8922 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8923 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, op1,
8924 target, unsignedp);
8925 return target;
8928 case REDUC_MAX_EXPR:
8929 case REDUC_MIN_EXPR:
8930 case REDUC_PLUS_EXPR:
8932 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8933 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8934 temp = expand_unop (mode, this_optab, op0, target, unsignedp);
8935 gcc_assert (temp);
8936 return temp;
8939 case VEC_LSHIFT_EXPR:
8940 case VEC_RSHIFT_EXPR:
8942 target = expand_vec_shift_expr (ops, target);
8943 return target;
8946 case VEC_UNPACK_HI_EXPR:
8947 case VEC_UNPACK_LO_EXPR:
8949 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8950 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
8951 target, unsignedp);
8952 gcc_assert (temp);
8953 return temp;
8956 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_HI_EXPR:
8957 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_LO_EXPR:
8959 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8960 /* The signedness is determined from input operand. */
8961 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr
8962 (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
8963 target, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8965 gcc_assert (temp);
8966 return temp;
8969 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_HI_EXPR:
8970 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_LO_EXPR:
8971 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_EVEN_EXPR:
8972 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_ODD_EXPR:
8973 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_HI_EXPR:
8974 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_LO_EXPR:
8975 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8976 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
8977 target, unsignedp);
8978 gcc_assert (target);
8979 return target;
8981 case VEC_PACK_TRUNC_EXPR:
8982 case VEC_PACK_SAT_EXPR:
8983 case VEC_PACK_FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
8984 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8985 goto binop;
8987 case VEC_PERM_EXPR:
8988 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8989 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8991 /* Careful here: if the target doesn't support integral vector modes,
8992 a constant selection vector could wind up smooshed into a normal
8993 integral constant. */
8994 if (CONSTANT_P (op2) && GET_CODE (op2) != CONST_VECTOR)
8996 tree sel_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop2);
8997 enum machine_mode vmode
8998 = mode_for_vector (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (sel_type)),
8999 TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (sel_type));
9000 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (vmode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT);
9001 op2 = simplify_subreg (vmode, op2, TYPE_MODE (sel_type), 0);
9002 gcc_assert (op2 && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_VECTOR);
9004 else
9005 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op2)) == MODE_VECTOR_INT);
9007 temp = expand_vec_perm (mode, op0, op1, op2, target);
9008 gcc_assert (temp);
9009 return temp;
9011 case DOT_PROD_EXPR:
9013 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9014 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9015 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9016 rtx op2;
9018 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9019 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9020 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
9021 target, unsignedp);
9022 return target;
9025 case REALIGN_LOAD_EXPR:
9027 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
9028 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
9029 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
9030 rtx op2;
9032 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9033 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9034 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
9035 temp = expand_ternary_op (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, op2,
9036 target, unsignedp);
9037 gcc_assert (temp);
9038 return temp;
9041 case COND_EXPR:
9042 /* A COND_EXPR with its type being VOID_TYPE represents a
9043 conditional jump and is handled in
9044 expand_gimple_cond_expr. */
9045 gcc_assert (!VOID_TYPE_P (type));
9047 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
9048 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
9049 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
9050 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
9052 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)
9053 && !ignore
9054 && TREE_TYPE (treeop1) != void_type_node
9055 && TREE_TYPE (treeop2) != void_type_node);
9057 temp = expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (treeop0, treeop1, treeop2);
9058 if (temp)
9059 return temp;
9061 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
9062 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
9063 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
9064 temporary. */
9066 if (modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9067 && original_target
9068 && safe_from_p (original_target, treeop0, 1)
9069 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
9070 && !MEM_P (original_target))
9071 temp = original_target;
9072 else
9073 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
9075 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9076 NO_DEFER_POP;
9077 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
9078 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
9079 jumpifnot (treeop0, op0, -1);
9080 store_expr (treeop1, temp,
9081 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9082 false);
9084 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (op1));
9085 emit_barrier ();
9086 emit_label (op0);
9087 store_expr (treeop2, temp,
9088 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9089 false);
9091 emit_label (op1);
9092 OK_DEFER_POP;
9093 return temp;
9095 case VEC_COND_EXPR:
9096 target = expand_vec_cond_expr (type, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2, target);
9097 return target;
9099 default:
9100 gcc_unreachable ();
9103 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator. */
9104 binop:
9105 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9106 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9107 binop2:
9108 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
9109 binop3:
9110 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9111 target = 0;
9112 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
9113 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
9114 gcc_assert (temp);
9115 /* Bitwise operations do not need bitfield reduction as we expect their
9116 operands being properly truncated. */
9117 if (code == BIT_XOR_EXPR
9118 || code == BIT_AND_EXPR
9119 || code == BIT_IOR_EXPR)
9120 return temp;
9121 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
9123 #undef REDUCE_BIT_FIELD
9126 expand_expr_real_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
9127 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
9129 rtx op0, op1, temp, decl_rtl;
9130 tree type;
9131 int unsignedp;
9132 enum machine_mode mode;
9133 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
9134 rtx subtarget, original_target;
9135 int ignore;
9136 tree context;
9137 bool reduce_bit_field;
9138 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
9139 struct separate_ops ops;
9140 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
9141 tree ssa_name = NULL_TREE;
9142 gimple g;
9144 type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
9145 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9146 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
9148 treeop0 = treeop1 = treeop2 = NULL_TREE;
9149 if (!VL_EXP_CLASS_P (exp))
9150 switch (TREE_CODE_LENGTH (code))
9152 default:
9153 case 3: treeop2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
9154 case 2: treeop1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
9155 case 1: treeop0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9156 case 0: break;
9158 ops.code = code;
9159 ops.type = type;
9160 ops.op0 = treeop0;
9161 ops.op1 = treeop1;
9162 ops.op2 = treeop2;
9163 ops.location = loc;
9165 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
9166 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
9167 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
9168 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
9170 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
9171 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
9172 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
9173 reduce_bit_field = (!ignore
9174 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
9175 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
9177 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
9178 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
9179 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
9180 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
9181 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
9183 if (ignore)
9185 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
9186 return const0_rtx;
9188 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
9189 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
9190 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
9191 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
9192 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
9193 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
9195 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
9196 if (MEM_P (temp))
9197 copy_to_reg (temp);
9198 return const0_rtx;
9201 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary
9202 || code == BIT_FIELD_REF
9203 || code == COMPONENT_REF
9204 || code == INDIRECT_REF)
9205 return expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
9206 modifier);
9208 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary
9209 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
9210 || code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
9212 expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9213 expand_expr (treeop1, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9214 return const0_rtx;
9217 target = 0;
9220 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9221 target = 0;
9223 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
9224 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
9225 original_target = target;
9227 switch (code)
9229 case LABEL_DECL:
9231 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
9233 temp = label_rtx (exp);
9234 temp = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp);
9236 if (function != current_function_decl
9237 && function != 0)
9238 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (temp) = 1;
9240 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, temp);
9241 return temp;
9244 case SSA_NAME:
9245 /* ??? ivopts calls expander, without any preparation from
9246 out-of-ssa. So fake instructions as if this was an access to the
9247 base variable. This unnecessarily allocates a pseudo, see how we can
9248 reuse it, if partition base vars have it set already. */
9249 if (!currently_expanding_to_rtl)
9251 tree var = SSA_NAME_VAR (exp);
9252 if (var && DECL_RTL_SET_P (var))
9253 return DECL_RTL (var);
9254 return gen_raw_REG (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9255 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1);
9258 g = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (exp);
9259 /* For EXPAND_INITIALIZER try harder to get something simpler. */
9260 if (g == NULL
9261 && modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9262 && !SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (exp)
9263 && (optimize || DECL_IGNORED_P (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp)))
9264 && stmt_is_replaceable_p (SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp)))
9265 g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp);
9266 if (g)
9268 rtx r;
9269 location_t saved_loc = curr_insn_location ();
9271 set_curr_insn_location (gimple_location (g));
9272 r = expand_expr_real (gimple_assign_rhs_to_tree (g), target,
9273 tmode, modifier, NULL);
9274 set_curr_insn_location (saved_loc);
9275 if (REG_P (r) && !REG_EXPR (r))
9276 set_reg_attrs_for_decl_rtl (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp), r);
9277 return r;
9280 ssa_name = exp;
9281 decl_rtl = get_rtx_for_ssa_name (ssa_name);
9282 exp = SSA_NAME_VAR (ssa_name);
9283 goto expand_decl_rtl;
9285 case PARM_DECL:
9286 case VAR_DECL:
9287 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
9288 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
9289 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
9290 && COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9291 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
9292 layout_decl (exp, 0);
9294 /* ... fall through ... */
9296 case FUNCTION_DECL:
9297 case RESULT_DECL:
9298 decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
9299 expand_decl_rtl:
9300 gcc_assert (decl_rtl);
9301 decl_rtl = copy_rtx (decl_rtl);
9302 /* Record writes to register variables. */
9303 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE
9304 && REG_P (decl_rtl)
9305 && HARD_REGISTER_P (decl_rtl))
9306 add_to_hard_reg_set (&crtl->asm_clobbers,
9307 GET_MODE (decl_rtl), REGNO (decl_rtl));
9309 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
9310 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
9311 definition. */
9312 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
9314 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
9315 temp = 0;
9317 /* Variables inherited from containing functions should have
9318 been lowered by this point. */
9319 context = decl_function_context (exp);
9320 gcc_assert (!context
9321 || context == current_function_decl
9322 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
9323 || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)
9324 /* ??? C++ creates functions that are not TREE_STATIC. */
9325 || TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL);
9327 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
9328 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
9329 ??? We aren't parsing while expanding anymore. */
9331 if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && REG_P (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
9332 temp = validize_mem (decl_rtl);
9334 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and the
9335 address is not valid, get the address into a register. */
9337 else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9339 if (alt_rtl)
9340 *alt_rtl = decl_rtl;
9341 decl_rtl = use_anchored_address (decl_rtl);
9342 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9343 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
9344 && !memory_address_addr_space_p (DECL_MODE (exp),
9345 XEXP (decl_rtl, 0),
9346 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (decl_rtl)))
9347 temp = replace_equiv_address (decl_rtl,
9348 copy_rtx (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)));
9351 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
9352 if the address is a register. */
9353 if (temp != 0)
9355 if (MEM_P (temp) && REG_P (XEXP (temp, 0)))
9356 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
9358 return temp;
9361 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl,
9362 there are two cases: we are dealing with a BLKmode value
9363 that is returned in a register, or we are dealing with
9364 a promoted value. In the latter case, return a SUBREG
9365 of the wanted mode, but mark it so that we know that it
9366 was already extended. */
9367 if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
9368 && DECL_MODE (exp) != BLKmode
9369 && GET_MODE (decl_rtl) != DECL_MODE (exp))
9371 enum machine_mode pmode;
9373 /* Get the signedness to be used for this variable. Ensure we get
9374 the same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
9375 if (code == SSA_NAME
9376 && (g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (ssa_name))
9377 && gimple_code (g) == GIMPLE_CALL)
9379 gcc_assert (!gimple_call_internal_p (g));
9380 pmode = promote_function_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp,
9381 gimple_call_fntype (g),
9384 else
9385 pmode = promote_decl_mode (exp, &unsignedp);
9386 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == pmode);
9388 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, decl_rtl);
9389 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
9390 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
9391 return temp;
9394 return decl_rtl;
9396 case INTEGER_CST:
9397 temp = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp),
9398 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (exp), mode);
9400 return temp;
9402 case VECTOR_CST:
9404 tree tmp = NULL_TREE;
9405 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT
9406 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT
9407 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FRACT
9408 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UFRACT
9409 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_ACCUM
9410 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UACCUM)
9411 return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
9412 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
9414 tree type_for_mode = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 1);
9415 if (type_for_mode)
9416 tmp = fold_unary_loc (loc, VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type_for_mode, exp);
9418 if (!tmp)
9420 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *v;
9421 unsigned i;
9422 vec_alloc (v, VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp));
9423 for (i = 0; i < VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp); ++i)
9424 CONSTRUCTOR_APPEND_ELT (v, NULL_TREE, VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i));
9425 tmp = build_constructor (type, v);
9427 return expand_expr (tmp, ignore ? const0_rtx : target,
9428 tmode, modifier);
9431 case CONST_DECL:
9432 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
9434 case REAL_CST:
9435 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
9436 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
9438 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
9439 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
9440 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
9441 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
9442 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
9444 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
9445 return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
9446 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9448 case FIXED_CST:
9449 return CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (exp),
9450 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9452 case COMPLEX_CST:
9453 /* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
9454 if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
9456 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9457 rtx rtarg, itarg;
9459 rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
9460 itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
9462 /* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
9463 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9464 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9466 if (op0 != rtarg)
9467 emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
9468 if (op1 != itarg)
9469 emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
9471 return original_target;
9474 /* ... fall through ... */
9476 case STRING_CST:
9477 temp = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
9479 /* temp contains a constant address.
9480 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
9481 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
9482 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9483 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9484 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
9485 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0),
9486 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (temp)))
9487 return replace_equiv_address (temp,
9488 copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
9489 return temp;
9491 case SAVE_EXPR:
9493 tree val = treeop0;
9494 rtx ret = expand_expr_real_1 (val, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
9496 if (!SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp))
9498 /* We can indeed still hit this case, typically via builtin
9499 expanders calling save_expr immediately before expanding
9500 something. Assume this means that we only have to deal
9501 with non-BLKmode values. */
9502 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (ret) != BLKmode);
9504 val = build_decl (curr_insn_location (),
9505 VAR_DECL, NULL, TREE_TYPE (exp));
9506 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (val) = 1;
9507 DECL_IGNORED_P (val) = 1;
9508 treeop0 = val;
9509 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = treeop0;
9510 SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp) = 1;
9512 if (!CONSTANT_P (ret))
9513 ret = copy_to_reg (ret);
9514 SET_DECL_RTL (val, ret);
9517 return ret;
9521 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9522 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
9523 subexpressions. */
9524 if (ignore)
9526 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
9527 tree value;
9529 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
9530 expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9532 return const0_rtx;
9535 return expand_constructor (exp, target, modifier, false);
9537 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
9539 addr_space_t as
9540 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
9541 struct mem_address addr;
9542 enum insn_code icode;
9543 unsigned int align;
9545 get_address_description (exp, &addr);
9546 op0 = addr_for_mem_ref (&addr, as, true);
9547 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
9548 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
9549 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
9550 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
9551 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
9552 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
9553 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9554 && mode != BLKmode
9555 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
9556 /* If the target does not have special handling for unaligned
9557 loads of mode then it can use regular moves for them. */
9558 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
9559 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
9561 struct expand_operand ops[2];
9563 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
9564 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
9565 nor can the generator. */
9566 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
9567 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
9568 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
9569 return ops[0].value;
9571 return temp;
9574 case MEM_REF:
9576 addr_space_t as
9577 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
9578 enum machine_mode address_mode;
9579 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9580 gimple def_stmt;
9581 enum insn_code icode;
9582 unsigned align;
9583 /* Handle expansion of non-aliased memory with non-BLKmode. That
9584 might end up in a register. */
9585 if (mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (exp))
9587 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = mem_ref_offset (exp).low;
9588 tree bit_offset;
9589 tree bftype;
9590 base = TREE_OPERAND (base, 0);
9591 if (offset == 0
9592 && host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), 1)
9593 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (base))
9594 == TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))))
9595 return expand_expr (build1 (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR,
9596 TREE_TYPE (exp), base),
9597 target, tmode, modifier);
9598 bit_offset = bitsize_int (offset * BITS_PER_UNIT);
9599 bftype = TREE_TYPE (base);
9600 if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != BLKmode)
9601 bftype = TREE_TYPE (exp);
9602 else
9604 temp = assign_stack_temp (DECL_MODE (base),
9605 GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (base)));
9606 store_expr (base, temp, 0, false);
9607 temp = adjust_address (temp, BLKmode, offset);
9608 set_mem_size (temp, int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9609 return temp;
9611 return expand_expr (build3 (BIT_FIELD_REF, bftype,
9612 base,
9613 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9614 bit_offset),
9615 target, tmode, modifier);
9617 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
9618 base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9619 if ((def_stmt = get_def_for_expr (base, BIT_AND_EXPR)))
9621 tree mask = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
9622 base = build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base),
9623 gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt), mask);
9624 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = base;
9626 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
9627 op0 = expand_expr (base, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
9628 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (address_mode, op0, as);
9629 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
9631 rtx off
9632 = immed_double_int_const (mem_ref_offset (exp), address_mode);
9633 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, address_mode, op0, off);
9635 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
9636 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
9637 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
9638 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
9639 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
9640 MEM_VOLATILE_P (temp) = 1;
9641 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
9642 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9643 && mode != BLKmode
9644 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
9646 if ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
9647 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
9649 struct expand_operand ops[2];
9651 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
9652 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
9653 nor can the generator. */
9654 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
9655 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
9656 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
9657 return ops[0].value;
9659 else if (SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, align))
9660 temp = extract_bit_field (temp, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
9661 0, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9662 true, (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9663 ? NULL_RTX : target),
9664 mode, mode);
9666 return temp;
9669 case ARRAY_REF:
9672 tree array = treeop0;
9673 tree index = treeop1;
9675 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
9676 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
9677 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
9678 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
9680 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9681 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9682 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
9684 tree t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
9686 if (t)
9687 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
9690 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
9691 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
9692 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
9693 that was declared const. */
9695 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9696 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9697 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9698 && TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
9699 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
9700 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
9702 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
9703 tree field, value;
9705 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (array), ix,
9706 field, value)
9707 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
9709 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
9710 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
9711 break;
9715 else if (optimize >= 1
9716 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9717 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9718 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9719 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
9720 && TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (array)
9721 && TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != ERROR_MARK
9722 && const_value_known_p (array))
9724 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
9726 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (array);
9728 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
9730 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
9731 tree field, value;
9733 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), ix,
9734 field, value)
9735 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
9737 if (TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
9738 break;
9740 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
9742 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this
9743 optimization is only useful if
9744 this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR
9745 into memory. If it does, it is more
9746 efficient to just load the data from
9747 the array directly. */
9748 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
9749 modifier, true);
9750 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
9751 break;
9754 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode,
9755 modifier);
9758 else if(TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST)
9760 tree index1 = index;
9761 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
9762 index1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
9763 treeop1);
9765 /* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
9767 We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
9768 with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
9769 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion,l (ARRAY
9770 +(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
9771 +INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Opps!) */
9773 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
9774 index1 = size_diffop_loc (loc, index1,
9775 fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
9776 low_bound));
9778 if (0 > compare_tree_int (index1,
9779 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)))
9781 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
9782 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9784 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
9785 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
9786 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
9787 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index1)],
9788 mode);
9794 goto normal_inner_ref;
9796 case COMPONENT_REF:
9797 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
9798 appropriate field if it is present. */
9799 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == CONSTRUCTOR)
9801 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
9802 tree field, value;
9804 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (treeop0),
9805 idx, field, value)
9806 if (field == treeop1
9807 /* We can normally use the value of the field in the
9808 CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
9809 an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
9810 we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
9811 since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
9812 the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
9813 we can't do this optimization. */
9814 && (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
9815 || ((GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (field)) == MODE_INT)
9816 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (DECL_MODE (field))
9817 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
9819 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
9820 && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9821 target = 0;
9822 op0 = expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
9823 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
9825 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (field));
9826 enum machine_mode imode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (field));
9828 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (field)))
9830 op1 = GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
9831 op0 = expand_and (imode, op0, op1, target);
9833 else
9835 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (imode) - bitsize;
9837 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
9838 target, 0);
9839 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
9840 target, 0);
9844 return op0;
9847 goto normal_inner_ref;
9849 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9850 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9851 normal_inner_ref:
9853 enum machine_mode mode1, mode2;
9854 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
9855 tree offset;
9856 int volatilep = 0, must_force_mem;
9857 bool packedp = false;
9858 tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
9859 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
9860 rtx orig_op0, memloc;
9861 bool mem_attrs_from_type = false;
9863 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
9864 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
9865 infinitely recurse. */
9866 gcc_assert (tem != exp);
9868 if (TYPE_PACKED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
9869 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == FIELD_DECL
9870 && DECL_PACKED (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
9871 packedp = true;
9873 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
9874 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
9875 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
9876 orig_op0 = op0
9877 = expand_expr (tem,
9878 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
9879 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (tem))
9880 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
9881 != INTEGER_CST)
9882 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9883 ? target : NULL_RTX),
9884 VOIDmode,
9885 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9886 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9887 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9888 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
9891 /* If the bitfield is volatile, we want to access it in the
9892 field's mode, not the computed mode.
9893 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
9894 use BLKmode for it instead. */
9895 if (MEM_P (op0))
9897 if (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
9898 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, 0);
9899 else if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
9900 op0 = adjust_address (op0, BLKmode, 0);
9903 mode2
9904 = CONSTANT_P (op0) ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) : GET_MODE (op0);
9906 /* If we have either an offset, a BLKmode result, or a reference
9907 outside the underlying object, we must force it to memory.
9908 Such a case can occur in Ada if we have unchecked conversion
9909 of an expression from a scalar type to an aggregate type or
9910 for an ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode, or if we were
9911 passed a partially uninitialized object or a view-conversion
9912 to a larger size. */
9913 must_force_mem = (offset
9914 || mode1 == BLKmode
9915 || bitpos + bitsize > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode2));
9917 /* Handle CONCAT first. */
9918 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT && !must_force_mem)
9920 if (bitpos == 0
9921 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
9922 return op0;
9923 if (bitpos == 0
9924 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9925 && bitsize)
9927 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
9928 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
9930 else if (bitpos == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9931 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 1)))
9932 && bitpos
9933 && bitsize)
9935 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
9936 bitpos = 0;
9937 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
9939 else
9940 /* Otherwise force into memory. */
9941 must_force_mem = 1;
9944 /* If this is a constant, put it in a register if it is a legitimate
9945 constant and we don't need a memory reference. */
9946 if (CONSTANT_P (op0)
9947 && mode2 != BLKmode
9948 && targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode2, op0)
9949 && !must_force_mem)
9950 op0 = force_reg (mode2, op0);
9952 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant, try to force it to the constant
9953 pool. Note that back-ends, e.g. MIPS, may refuse to do so if it
9954 is a legitimate constant. */
9955 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) && (memloc = force_const_mem (mode2, op0)))
9956 op0 = validize_mem (memloc);
9958 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant or the object is not in memory
9959 and need be, put it there. */
9960 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) || (!MEM_P (op0) && must_force_mem))
9962 tree nt = build_qualified_type (TREE_TYPE (tem),
9963 (TYPE_QUALS (TREE_TYPE (tem))
9964 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST));
9965 memloc = assign_temp (nt, 1, 1);
9966 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
9967 op0 = memloc;
9968 mem_attrs_from_type = true;
9971 if (offset)
9973 enum machine_mode address_mode;
9974 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
9975 EXPAND_SUM);
9977 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0));
9979 address_mode = get_address_mode (op0);
9980 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
9981 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
9983 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode
9984 /* A constant address in OP0 can have VOIDmode, we must
9985 not try to call force_reg in that case. */
9986 && GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) != VOIDmode
9987 && bitsize != 0
9988 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
9989 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
9990 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
9992 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9993 bitpos = 0;
9996 op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
9997 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
10000 /* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
10001 record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10002 if (MEM_P (op0) && bitpos == 0 && offset != 0
10003 && is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
10004 set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
10006 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
10007 if (MEM_P (op0) && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
10009 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10010 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10012 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
10015 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
10016 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
10017 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
10018 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
10019 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
10020 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
10021 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
10022 || REG_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
10023 || (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
10024 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
10025 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
10026 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10027 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10028 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
10029 /* If the field is volatile, we always want an aligned
10030 access. Do this in following two situations:
10031 1. the access is not already naturally
10032 aligned, otherwise "normal" (non-bitfield) volatile fields
10033 become non-addressable.
10034 2. the bitsize is narrower than the access size. Need
10035 to extract bitfields from the access. */
10036 || (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0
10037 && (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0
10038 || (mode1 != BLKmode
10039 && bitsize < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode1) * BITS_PER_UNIT)))
10040 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
10041 fetch it as a bit field. */
10042 || (mode1 != BLKmode
10043 && (((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
10044 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0)
10045 || (MEM_P (op0)
10046 && (MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)
10047 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1) != 0))))
10048 && ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10049 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10050 ? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
10051 : SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode1, MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
10052 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
10053 /* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
10054 size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
10055 we must use bitfield operations. */
10056 || (bitsize >= 0
10057 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
10058 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
10059 && 0 != compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
10060 bitsize)))
10062 enum machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
10064 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
10065 && ! (target != 0 && MEM_P (op0)
10066 && MEM_P (target)
10067 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0))
10068 ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
10070 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
10072 if (target == 0)
10073 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
10075 if (bitsize == 0)
10076 return target;
10078 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
10079 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
10080 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0)
10081 && (!target || MEM_P (target))
10082 && !(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
10084 emit_block_move (target,
10085 adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode,
10086 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT),
10087 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
10088 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
10089 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10090 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
10092 return target;
10095 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
10097 if (MEM_P (op0) && REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10098 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10100 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp, packedp,
10101 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10102 ? NULL_RTX : target),
10103 ext_mode, ext_mode);
10105 /* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
10106 the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
10107 machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
10108 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10109 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
10110 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
10111 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
10112 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
10113 - bitsize, op0, 1);
10115 /* If the result type is BLKmode, store the data into a temporary
10116 of the appropriate type, but with the mode corresponding to the
10117 mode for the data we have (op0's mode). It's tempting to make
10118 this a constant type, since we know it's only being stored once,
10119 but that can cause problems if we are taking the address of this
10120 COMPONENT_REF because the MEM of any reference via that address
10121 will have flags corresponding to the type, which will not
10122 necessarily be constant. */
10123 if (mode == BLKmode)
10125 rtx new_rtx;
10127 new_rtx = assign_stack_temp_for_type (ext_mode,
10128 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ext_mode),
10129 type);
10130 emit_move_insn (new_rtx, op0);
10131 op0 = copy_rtx (new_rtx);
10132 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
10135 return op0;
10138 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
10139 now as well. */
10140 if (mode == BLKmode)
10141 mode1 = BLKmode;
10143 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
10144 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10145 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10146 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10147 else
10148 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10150 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10151 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10153 /* If op0 is a temporary because of forcing to memory, pass only the
10154 type to set_mem_attributes so that the original expression is never
10155 marked as ADDRESSABLE through MEM_EXPR of the temporary. */
10156 if (mem_attrs_from_type)
10157 set_mem_attributes (op0, type, 0);
10158 else
10159 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
10161 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10162 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10164 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
10165 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
10166 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10167 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10168 return op0;
10169 else if (target == 0)
10170 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
10172 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
10173 return target;
10176 case OBJ_TYPE_REF:
10177 return expand_expr (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
10179 case CALL_EXPR:
10180 /* All valid uses of __builtin_va_arg_pack () are removed during
10181 inlining. */
10182 if (CALL_EXPR_VA_ARG_PACK (exp))
10183 error ("%Kinvalid use of %<__builtin_va_arg_pack ()%>", exp);
10185 tree fndecl = get_callee_fndecl (exp), attr;
10187 if (fndecl
10188 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("error",
10189 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
10190 error ("%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute error: %s",
10191 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
10192 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
10193 if (fndecl
10194 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("warning",
10195 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
10196 warning_at (tree_nonartificial_location (exp),
10197 0, "%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute warning: %s",
10198 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
10199 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
10201 /* Check for a built-in function. */
10202 if (fndecl && DECL_BUILT_IN (fndecl))
10204 gcc_assert (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (fndecl) != BUILT_IN_FRONTEND);
10205 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
10208 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
10210 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10211 op0 = NULL_RTX;
10213 /* If we are converting to BLKmode, try to avoid an intermediate
10214 temporary by fetching an inner memory reference. */
10215 if (mode == BLKmode
10216 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
10217 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != BLKmode
10218 && handled_component_p (treeop0))
10220 enum machine_mode mode1;
10221 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
10222 tree offset;
10223 int unsignedp;
10224 int volatilep = 0;
10225 tree tem
10226 = get_inner_reference (treeop0, &bitsize, &bitpos,
10227 &offset, &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep,
10228 true);
10229 rtx orig_op0;
10231 /* ??? We should work harder and deal with non-zero offsets. */
10232 if (!offset
10233 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
10234 && bitsize >= 0
10235 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) == 0)
10237 /* See the normal_inner_ref case for the rationale. */
10238 orig_op0
10239 = expand_expr (tem,
10240 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
10241 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
10242 != INTEGER_CST)
10243 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10244 ? target : NULL_RTX),
10245 VOIDmode,
10246 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10247 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10248 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10249 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
10251 if (MEM_P (orig_op0))
10253 op0 = orig_op0;
10255 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
10256 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10257 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM
10258 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10259 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10260 else
10261 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10263 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10264 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10266 set_mem_attributes (op0, treeop0, 0);
10267 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10268 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10270 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
10275 if (!op0)
10276 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0,
10277 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
10279 /* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done. */
10280 if (mode == GET_MODE (op0))
10282 /* If neither mode is BLKmode, and both modes are the same size
10283 then we can use gen_lowpart. */
10284 else if (mode != BLKmode && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
10285 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)
10286 == GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (op0)))
10287 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0)))
10289 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
10290 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
10291 temp = gen_lowpart_common (mode, op0);
10292 if (temp)
10293 op0 = temp;
10294 else
10296 if (!REG_P (op0) && !MEM_P (op0))
10297 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
10298 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
10301 /* If both types are integral, convert from one mode to the other. */
10302 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
10303 op0 = convert_modes (mode, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
10304 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
10305 /* As a last resort, spill op0 to memory, and reload it in a
10306 different mode. */
10307 else if (!MEM_P (op0))
10309 /* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
10310 are going to be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
10311 force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
10312 constants to change mode. */
10313 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
10315 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
10317 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
10318 target
10319 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
10320 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
10321 GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), inner_type);
10323 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
10324 op0 = target;
10327 /* At this point, OP0 is in the correct mode. If the output type is
10328 such that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate that it is.
10329 Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for non-BLKmode
10330 results. */
10331 if (MEM_P (op0))
10333 enum insn_code icode;
10335 if (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (type))
10337 /* ??? Copying the MEM without substantially changing it might
10338 run afoul of the code handling volatile memory references in
10339 store_expr, which assumes that TARGET is returned unmodified
10340 if it has been used. */
10341 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10342 set_mem_align (op0, MAX (MEM_ALIGN (op0), TYPE_ALIGN (type)));
10344 else if (mode != BLKmode
10345 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
10346 /* If the target does have special handling for unaligned
10347 loads of mode then use them. */
10348 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
10349 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
10351 rtx reg, insn;
10353 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
10354 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
10355 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't
10356 fail. */
10357 reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10359 /* Nor can the insn generator. */
10360 insn = GEN_FCN (icode) (reg, op0);
10361 emit_insn (insn);
10362 return reg;
10364 else if (STRICT_ALIGNMENT
10365 && mode != BLKmode
10366 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
10368 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
10369 HOST_WIDE_INT temp_size
10370 = MAX (int_size_in_bytes (inner_type),
10371 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
10372 rtx new_rtx
10373 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, temp_size, type);
10374 rtx new_with_op0_mode
10375 = adjust_address (new_rtx, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
10377 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
10379 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
10380 emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0,
10381 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
10382 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10383 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
10384 else
10385 emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
10387 op0 = new_rtx;
10390 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
10393 return op0;
10395 case MODIFY_EXPR:
10397 tree lhs = treeop0;
10398 tree rhs = treeop1;
10399 gcc_assert (ignore);
10401 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
10402 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
10403 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
10404 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
10406 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
10407 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
10408 support it. */
10409 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
10410 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
10411 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
10412 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
10413 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
10414 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
10415 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
10417 rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
10418 int value = TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR;
10419 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1),
10420 value ? label : 0,
10421 value ? 0 : label, -1);
10422 expand_assignment (lhs, build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (rhs), value),
10423 false);
10424 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10425 emit_label (label);
10426 return const0_rtx;
10429 expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, false);
10430 return const0_rtx;
10433 case ADDR_EXPR:
10434 return expand_expr_addr_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
10436 case REALPART_EXPR:
10437 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10438 return read_complex_part (op0, false);
10440 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
10441 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10442 return read_complex_part (op0, true);
10444 case RETURN_EXPR:
10445 case LABEL_EXPR:
10446 case GOTO_EXPR:
10447 case SWITCH_EXPR:
10448 case ASM_EXPR:
10449 /* Expanded in cfgexpand.c. */
10450 gcc_unreachable ();
10452 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
10453 case CATCH_EXPR:
10454 case EH_FILTER_EXPR:
10455 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
10456 /* Lowered by tree-eh.c. */
10457 gcc_unreachable ();
10459 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
10460 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
10461 case TARGET_EXPR:
10462 case CASE_LABEL_EXPR:
10463 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
10464 case BIND_EXPR:
10465 case INIT_EXPR:
10466 case CONJ_EXPR:
10467 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
10468 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
10469 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
10470 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
10471 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
10472 case LOOP_EXPR:
10473 case EXIT_EXPR:
10474 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
10475 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
10476 gcc_unreachable ();
10478 case FDESC_EXPR:
10479 /* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
10480 initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
10481 gcc_unreachable ();
10483 case WITH_SIZE_EXPR:
10484 /* WITH_SIZE_EXPR expands to its first argument. The caller should
10485 have pulled out the size to use in whatever context it needed. */
10486 return expand_expr_real (treeop0, original_target, tmode,
10487 modifier, alt_rtl);
10489 default:
10490 return expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
10494 /* Subroutine of above: reduce EXP to the precision of TYPE (in the
10495 signedness of TYPE), possibly returning the result in TARGET. */
10496 static rtx
10497 reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx exp, rtx target, tree type)
10499 HOST_WIDE_INT prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
10500 if (target && GET_MODE (target) != GET_MODE (exp))
10501 target = 0;
10502 /* For constant values, reduce using build_int_cst_type. */
10503 if (CONST_INT_P (exp))
10505 HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (exp);
10506 tree t = build_int_cst_type (type, value);
10507 return expand_expr (t, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10509 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10511 rtx mask = immed_double_int_const (double_int::mask (prec),
10512 GET_MODE (exp));
10513 return expand_and (GET_MODE (exp), exp, mask, target);
10515 else
10517 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (exp)) - prec;
10518 exp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp),
10519 exp, count, target, 0);
10520 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp),
10521 exp, count, target, 0);
10525 /* Subroutine of above: returns 1 if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
10526 when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
10527 aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10529 static int
10530 is_aligning_offset (const_tree offset, const_tree exp)
10532 /* Strip off any conversions. */
10533 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10534 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10536 /* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
10537 power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10538 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
10539 || !host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1)
10540 || compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1),
10541 BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) <= 0
10542 || !exact_log2 (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1) + 1) < 0)
10543 return 0;
10545 /* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
10546 It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
10547 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10548 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10549 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10551 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
10552 return 0;
10554 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10555 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10556 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10558 /* This must now be the address of EXP. */
10559 return TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp;
10562 /* Return the tree node if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
10563 if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the offset
10564 in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing. The type of the
10565 offset will be `sizetype'. */
10567 tree
10568 string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset)
10570 tree array, offset, lower_bound;
10571 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
10573 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR)
10575 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == STRING_CST)
10577 *ptr_offset = size_zero_node;
10578 return TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10580 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == VAR_DECL)
10582 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10583 offset = size_zero_node;
10585 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == ARRAY_REF)
10587 array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
10588 offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
10589 if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
10590 && TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
10591 return 0;
10593 /* Check if the array has a nonzero lower bound. */
10594 lower_bound = array_ref_low_bound (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0));
10595 if (!integer_zerop (lower_bound))
10597 /* If the offset and base aren't both constants, return 0. */
10598 if (TREE_CODE (lower_bound) != INTEGER_CST)
10599 return 0;
10600 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != INTEGER_CST)
10601 return 0;
10602 /* Adjust offset by the lower bound. */
10603 offset = size_diffop (fold_convert (sizetype, offset),
10604 fold_convert (sizetype, lower_bound));
10607 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == MEM_REF)
10609 array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
10610 offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
10611 if (TREE_CODE (array) != ADDR_EXPR)
10612 return 0;
10613 array = TREE_OPERAND (array, 0);
10614 if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
10615 && TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
10616 return 0;
10618 else
10619 return 0;
10621 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR || TREE_CODE (arg) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
10623 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10624 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
10626 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
10627 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
10629 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == ADDR_EXPR
10630 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == STRING_CST
10631 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
10633 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
10634 offset = arg1;
10636 else if (TREE_CODE (arg1) == ADDR_EXPR
10637 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == STRING_CST
10638 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
10640 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0);
10641 offset = arg0;
10643 else
10644 return 0;
10646 else
10647 return 0;
10649 if (TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST)
10651 *ptr_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
10652 return array;
10654 else if (TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL
10655 || TREE_CODE (array) == CONST_DECL)
10657 int length;
10659 /* Variables initialized to string literals can be handled too. */
10660 if (!const_value_known_p (array)
10661 || !DECL_INITIAL (array)
10662 || TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != STRING_CST)
10663 return 0;
10665 /* Avoid const char foo[4] = "abcde"; */
10666 if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array) == NULL_TREE
10667 || TREE_CODE (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array)) != INTEGER_CST
10668 || (length = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (DECL_INITIAL (array))) <= 0
10669 || compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) < 0)
10670 return 0;
10672 /* If variable is bigger than the string literal, OFFSET must be constant
10673 and inside of the bounds of the string literal. */
10674 offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
10675 if (compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) > 0
10676 && (! host_integerp (offset, 1)
10677 || compare_tree_int (offset, length) >= 0))
10678 return 0;
10680 *ptr_offset = offset;
10681 return DECL_INITIAL (array);
10684 return 0;
10687 /* Generate code to calculate OPS, and exploded expression
10688 using a store-flag instruction and return an rtx for the result.
10689 OPS reflects a comparison.
10691 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
10693 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
10694 available on this machine.
10696 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
10697 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
10698 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
10699 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
10700 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
10701 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
10702 set/jump/set sequence. */
10704 static rtx
10705 do_store_flag (sepops ops, rtx target, enum machine_mode mode)
10707 enum rtx_code code;
10708 tree arg0, arg1, type;
10709 tree tem;
10710 enum machine_mode operand_mode;
10711 int unsignedp;
10712 rtx op0, op1;
10713 rtx subtarget = target;
10714 location_t loc = ops->location;
10716 arg0 = ops->op0;
10717 arg1 = ops->op1;
10719 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
10720 if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
10721 return const0_rtx;
10723 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
10724 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
10725 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
10727 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
10728 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
10729 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
10730 return 0;
10732 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
10733 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
10734 #ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
10735 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
10736 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)) == POINTER_TYPE
10737 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)))
10738 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
10739 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)) == POINTER_TYPE
10740 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)))
10741 == FUNCTION_TYPE))))
10742 return 0;
10743 #endif
10745 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
10746 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
10748 /* For vector typed comparisons emit code to generate the desired
10749 all-ones or all-zeros mask. Conveniently use the VEC_COND_EXPR
10750 expander for this. */
10751 if (TREE_CODE (ops->type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10753 tree ifexp = build2 (ops->code, ops->type, arg0, arg1);
10754 tree if_true = constant_boolean_node (true, ops->type);
10755 tree if_false = constant_boolean_node (false, ops->type);
10756 return expand_vec_cond_expr (ops->type, ifexp, if_true, if_false, target);
10759 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
10760 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
10761 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
10762 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
10763 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
10764 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
10766 switch (ops->code)
10768 case EQ_EXPR:
10769 code = EQ;
10770 break;
10771 case NE_EXPR:
10772 code = NE;
10773 break;
10774 case LT_EXPR:
10775 if (integer_onep (arg1))
10776 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
10777 else
10778 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
10779 break;
10780 case LE_EXPR:
10781 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
10782 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
10783 else
10784 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
10785 break;
10786 case GT_EXPR:
10787 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
10788 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
10789 else
10790 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
10791 break;
10792 case GE_EXPR:
10793 if (integer_onep (arg1))
10794 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
10795 else
10796 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
10797 break;
10799 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
10800 code = UNORDERED;
10801 break;
10802 case ORDERED_EXPR:
10803 code = ORDERED;
10804 break;
10805 case UNLT_EXPR:
10806 code = UNLT;
10807 break;
10808 case UNLE_EXPR:
10809 code = UNLE;
10810 break;
10811 case UNGT_EXPR:
10812 code = UNGT;
10813 break;
10814 case UNGE_EXPR:
10815 code = UNGE;
10816 break;
10817 case UNEQ_EXPR:
10818 code = UNEQ;
10819 break;
10820 case LTGT_EXPR:
10821 code = LTGT;
10822 break;
10824 default:
10825 gcc_unreachable ();
10828 /* Put a constant second. */
10829 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST
10830 || TREE_CODE (arg0) == FIXED_CST)
10832 tem = arg0; arg0 = arg1; arg1 = tem;
10833 code = swap_condition (code);
10836 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
10837 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
10838 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
10839 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
10840 than an scc insn even if we have it.
10842 The code to make this transformation was moved into fold_single_bit_test,
10843 so we just call into the folder and expand its result. */
10845 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
10846 && integer_zerop (arg1)
10847 && (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) != 1 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)))
10849 gimple srcstmt = get_def_for_expr (arg0, BIT_AND_EXPR);
10850 if (srcstmt
10851 && integer_pow2p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt)))
10853 enum tree_code tcode = code == NE ? NE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR;
10854 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
10855 tree temp = fold_build2_loc (loc, BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (arg1),
10856 gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt),
10857 gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
10858 temp = fold_single_bit_test (loc, tcode, temp, arg1, type);
10859 if (temp)
10860 return expand_expr (temp, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10864 if (! get_subtarget (target)
10865 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode)
10866 subtarget = 0;
10868 expand_operands (arg0, arg1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10870 if (target == 0)
10871 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10873 /* Try a cstore if possible. */
10874 return emit_store_flag_force (target, code, op0, op1,
10875 operand_mode, unsignedp,
10876 (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) == 1
10877 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)) ? -1 : 1);
10881 /* Stubs in case we haven't got a casesi insn. */
10882 #ifndef HAVE_casesi
10883 # define HAVE_casesi 0
10884 # define gen_casesi(a, b, c, d, e) (0)
10885 # define CODE_FOR_casesi CODE_FOR_nothing
10886 #endif
10888 /* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns 1 if successful,
10889 0 otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction).
10891 DEFAULT_PROBABILITY is the probability of jumping to the default
10892 label. */
10894 try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
10895 rtx table_label, rtx default_label, rtx fallback_label,
10896 int default_probability)
10898 struct expand_operand ops[5];
10899 enum machine_mode index_mode = SImode;
10900 rtx op1, op2, index;
10902 if (! HAVE_casesi)
10903 return 0;
10905 /* Convert the index to SImode. */
10906 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (index_type)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
10908 enum machine_mode omode = TYPE_MODE (index_type);
10909 rtx rangertx = expand_normal (range);
10911 /* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
10912 index_expr = build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
10913 index_expr, minval);
10914 minval = integer_zero_node;
10915 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10916 if (default_label)
10917 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
10918 omode, 1, default_label,
10919 default_probability);
10920 /* Now we can safely truncate. */
10921 index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
10923 else
10925 if (TYPE_MODE (index_type) != index_mode)
10927 index_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (index_mode, 0);
10928 index_expr = fold_convert (index_type, index_expr);
10931 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10934 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10936 op1 = expand_normal (minval);
10937 op2 = expand_normal (range);
10939 create_input_operand (&ops[0], index, index_mode);
10940 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[1], op1, TREE_TYPE (minval));
10941 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[2], op2, TREE_TYPE (range));
10942 create_fixed_operand (&ops[3], table_label);
10943 create_fixed_operand (&ops[4], (default_label
10944 ? default_label
10945 : fallback_label));
10946 expand_jump_insn (CODE_FOR_casesi, 5, ops);
10947 return 1;
10950 /* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
10951 #ifndef HAVE_tablejump
10952 #define HAVE_tablejump 0
10953 #define gen_tablejump(x, y) (0)
10954 #endif
10956 /* Subroutine of the next function.
10958 INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
10959 in the table already subtracted.
10960 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
10961 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
10962 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
10964 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
10965 index value is out of range.
10966 DEFAULT_PROBABILITY is the probability of jumping to
10967 the default label. */
10969 static void
10970 do_tablejump (rtx index, enum machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
10971 rtx default_label, int default_probability)
10973 rtx temp, vector;
10975 if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents)
10976 cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
10978 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
10979 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
10980 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
10981 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
10982 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
10983 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
10984 the maximum value of the range. */
10986 if (default_label)
10987 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
10988 default_label, default_probability);
10991 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
10992 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
10993 if (mode != Pmode)
10994 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
10996 /* Don't let a MEM slip through, because then INDEX that comes
10997 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
10998 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
10999 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
11000 if (flag_pic && !REG_P (index))
11001 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
11002 #endif
11004 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
11005 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
11006 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
11007 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
11008 index = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
11009 gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, index,
11010 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE))),
11011 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
11012 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
11013 if (flag_pic)
11014 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
11015 else
11016 #endif
11017 index = memory_address (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
11018 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
11019 vector = gen_const_mem (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
11020 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
11022 emit_jump_insn (gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
11024 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
11025 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
11026 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
11027 emit_barrier ();
11031 try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
11032 rtx table_label, rtx default_label, int default_probability)
11034 rtx index;
11036 if (! HAVE_tablejump)
11037 return 0;
11039 index_expr = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
11040 fold_convert (index_type, index_expr),
11041 fold_convert (index_type, minval));
11042 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
11043 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
11045 do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
11046 convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
11047 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
11048 expand_normal (range),
11049 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
11050 table_label, default_label, default_probability);
11051 return 1;
11054 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
11055 static rtx
11056 const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
11058 rtvec v;
11059 unsigned i;
11060 int units;
11061 tree elt;
11062 enum machine_mode inner, mode;
11064 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
11066 if (initializer_zerop (exp))
11067 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
11069 units = GET_MODE_NUNITS (mode);
11070 inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
11072 v = rtvec_alloc (units);
11074 for (i = 0; i < VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp); ++i)
11076 elt = VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i);
11078 if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
11079 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
11080 inner);
11081 else if (TREE_CODE (elt) == FIXED_CST)
11082 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (elt),
11083 inner);
11084 else
11085 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = immed_double_int_const (tree_to_double_int (elt),
11086 inner);
11089 return gen_rtx_CONST_VECTOR (mode, v);
11092 /* Build a decl for a personality function given a language prefix. */
11094 tree
11095 build_personality_function (const char *lang)
11097 const char *unwind_and_version;
11098 tree decl, type;
11099 char *name;
11101 switch (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options))
11103 case UI_NONE:
11104 return NULL;
11105 case UI_SJLJ:
11106 unwind_and_version = "_sj0";
11107 break;
11108 case UI_DWARF2:
11109 case UI_TARGET:
11110 unwind_and_version = "_v0";
11111 break;
11112 case UI_SEH:
11113 unwind_and_version = "_seh0";
11114 break;
11115 default:
11116 gcc_unreachable ();
11119 name = ACONCAT (("__", lang, "_personality", unwind_and_version, NULL));
11121 type = build_function_type_list (integer_type_node, integer_type_node,
11122 long_long_unsigned_type_node,
11123 ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
11124 decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL,
11125 get_identifier (name), type);
11126 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = 1;
11127 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
11128 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = 1;
11130 /* Zap the nonsensical SYMBOL_REF_DECL for this. What we're left with
11131 are the flags assigned by targetm.encode_section_info. */
11132 SET_SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), NULL);
11134 return decl;
11137 /* Extracts the personality function of DECL and returns the corresponding
11138 libfunc. */
11141 get_personality_function (tree decl)
11143 tree personality = DECL_FUNCTION_PERSONALITY (decl);
11144 enum eh_personality_kind pk;
11146 pk = function_needs_eh_personality (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
11147 if (pk == eh_personality_none)
11148 return NULL;
11150 if (!personality
11151 && pk == eh_personality_any)
11152 personality = lang_hooks.eh_personality ();
11154 if (pk == eh_personality_lang)
11155 gcc_assert (personality != NULL_TREE);
11157 return XEXP (DECL_RTL (personality), 0);
11160 #include "gt-expr.h"